blob: 35157f18e0732dbcb6e01440b23a5bf7e864d1f3 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Christopher Faulet6cfe7872023-12-14 14:50:17 +01006 2023/12/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
Daniel Epperson07ff2fb2023-05-15 12:45:27 -0700452.6. Size format
462.7. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400340over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400384 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400386 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600615quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400693Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600694that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600699Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
700if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
701or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
702
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
705 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
706
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100707When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
708double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600709and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100710a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
711a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
712the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
713regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
714around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
715more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200716
717
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007182.3. Environment variables
719--------------------------
720
721HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
722interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
723configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
724optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
725shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200726underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
727list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
728arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
729before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200730
731 Example:
732
733 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
734
735 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
736
737 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
738
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
740file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200741
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200742* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
743 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
744
745* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
746 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
747 directory.
748
749* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
750
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500751* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200752 processes, separated by semicolons.
753
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500754* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200755 CLI, separated by semicolons.
756
William Lallemanda48f51b2023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100757* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
758 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
759 updating the binary and reloading.
760
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200761In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
762regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
763only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
764
765* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
766
767* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
768 starting at one.
769
770* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
771 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
772 first section.
773
774These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
775if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
776section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
777"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
778proxies.
779
780This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
781logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
782to name some config objects like servers for example.
783
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200784See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200785
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100786
7872.4. Conditional blocks
788-----------------------
789
790It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
791some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
792ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
793configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
794versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
795preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
796text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
797lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
798switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
799are defined to form conditional blocks:
800
801 - .if <condition>
802 - .elif <condition>
803 - .else
804 - .endif
805
806The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
807as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
808matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
809there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
810only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
811".elif" of a block.
812
813Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
814ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
815as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
816
817The conditions are currently limited to:
818
819 - an empty string, always returns "false"
820 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
821 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200822 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
823
824The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
825
826 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
827 exists, regardless of its contents
828
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200829 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
830 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
831 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
832
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200833 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
834 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
835
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200836 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
837 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
838 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
839 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
840
841 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
842 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
843 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
844 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
845
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200846Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100847
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200848 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
849 listen mwcli_px
850 bind :1111
851 ...
852 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100853
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200854 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
855 bind :80
856 .endif
857
858 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200859 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200860 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200861 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200862 .endif
863
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200864 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
865 profiling.memory on
866 .endif
867
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200868Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100869
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200870 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100871 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
872 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
873 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
874
875Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
876"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
877fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
878provide advice to the user.
879
880Example:
881
882 .if "${A}"
883 .if "${B}"
884 .notice "A=1, B=1"
885 .elif "${C}"
886 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
887 .elif "${D}"
888 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
889 .else
890 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
891 .endif
892 .else
893 .notice "A=0"
894 .endif
895
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200896 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
897 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
898
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100899
9002.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200901----------------
902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100903Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100904values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
905otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
906numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
907for every keyword. Supported units are :
908
909 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
910 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
911 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
912 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
913 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
914 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
915
916
Daniel Epperson07ff2fb2023-05-15 12:45:27 -07009172.6. Size format
918----------------
919
920Some parameters involve values representing size, such as bandwidth limits.
921These values are generally expressed in bytes (unless explicitly stated
922otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
923numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
924for every keyword. Supported units are case insensitive :
925
926 - k : kilobytes. 1 kilobyte = 1024 bytes
927 - m : megabytes. 1 megabyte = 1048576 bytes
928 - g : gigabytes. 1 gigabyte = 1073741824 bytes
929
930Both time and size formats require integers, decimal notation is not allowed.
931
932
9332.7. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200934-------------
935
936 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
937 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
938 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
939 global
940 daemon
941 maxconn 256
942
943 defaults
944 mode http
945 timeout connect 5000ms
946 timeout client 50000ms
947 timeout server 50000ms
948
949 frontend http-in
950 bind *:80
951 default_backend servers
952
953 backend servers
954 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
955
956
957 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
958 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
959 global
960 daemon
961 maxconn 256
962
963 defaults
964 mode http
965 timeout connect 5000ms
966 timeout client 50000ms
967 timeout server 50000ms
968
969 listen http-in
970 bind *:80
971 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
972
973
974Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
975
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100976 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200977
978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009793. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200980--------------------
981
982Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
983are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
984of them have command-line equivalents.
985
986The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
987
988 * Process management and security
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100989 - 51degrees-cache-size
990 - 51degrees-data-file
991 - 51degrees-property-name-list
992 - 51degrees-property-separator
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200993 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994 - chroot
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200995 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100996 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200997 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200998 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200999 - description
1000 - deviceatlas-json-file
1001 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001002 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001003 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001004 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001005 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - gid
1007 - group
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001008 - h1-case-adjust
1009 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001010 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1011 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001012 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001013 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001014 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001015 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001016 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001017 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001018 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001020 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001021 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001022 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001023 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001024 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001025 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001026 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001027 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001028 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001029 - presetenv
1030 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001031 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001032 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001033 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001034 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001035 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001036 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001037 - ssl-default-bind-options
1038 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001039 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001040 - ssl-default-server-options
1041 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001042 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001043 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001044 - stats
1045 - strict-limits
1046 - uid
1047 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001048 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001049 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001050 - user
1051 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001052 - wurfl-data-file
1053 - wurfl-information-list
1054 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001055
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001057 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001058 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001059 - maxcompcpuusage
1060 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001062 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001063 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001064 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001065 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001066 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001067 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001068 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001070 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001071 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001072 - nokqueue
1073 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001074 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001075 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001076 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001077 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001078 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001079 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001080 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001081 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001082 - tune.buffers.limit
1083 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001084 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001085 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001086 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet48110bc2023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001087 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001088 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001089 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001090 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001091 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Tim Duesterhus1da7ab32023-06-13 15:08:47 +02001092 - tune.h2.max-frame-size
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001093 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001094 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001095 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001096 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001097 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001098 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001099 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001100 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001101 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1102 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001103 - tune.maxaccept
1104 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001105 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001106 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001107 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001108 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1109 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001110 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1111 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001112 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001113 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001114 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001115 - tune.sndbuf.client
1116 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001117 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001118 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
1119 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
1120 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001121 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001122 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1123 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001124 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001125 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001126 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001127 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1128 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1129 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001130 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1131 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001132
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001134 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001135 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136
1137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011383.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001139------------------------------------
1140
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100114151degrees-data-file <file path>
1142 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1143 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1144
1145 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1146 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1147
114851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1149 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1150 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1151 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1152
1153 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1154 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1155
115651degrees-property-separator <char>
1157 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1158 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1159
1160 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1161 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1162
116351degrees-cache-size <number>
1164 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1165 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1166 By default, this cache is disabled.
1167
1168 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1169 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1170
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001171ca-base <dir>
1172 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001173 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1174 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1175 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177chroot <jail dir>
1178 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1179 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1180 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1181 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1182 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001183 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001184
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001185cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1186 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1187 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1188 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1189 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1190 set. These sets have the format
1191
1192 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1193
1194 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001195 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001196 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1197 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001198 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1199 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001200 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1201 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1202 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1203 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1204 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1205 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1206 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1207 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1208 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1209 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001210
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001211 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1212 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1213 on the machine's word size.
1214
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001215 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001216 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1217 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1218 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1219 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1220 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1221 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001222
1223 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001224 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1225
1226 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1227 # first 4 CPUs
1228
1229 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1230 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1231 # word size.
1232
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001233 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001234 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001235 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1236 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1237 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1238
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001239 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1240 # and so on.
1241 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1242 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1243 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1244
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001245 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001246 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1247 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1248 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1249
1250 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1251 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1252 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1253
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001254 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1255 # and a thread range.
1256 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1257 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1258 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1259
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001260crt-base <dir>
1261 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001262 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1263 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001264
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001265daemon
1266 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1267 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001268 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1269 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001270
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001271default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001272 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001273 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1274 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1275 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1276 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1277 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1278 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1279 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1280 not start with a slash ('/'):
1281 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1282 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1283
1284 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1285 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1286 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1287 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1288 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1289 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1290 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1291 each of them.
1292
1293 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1294 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1295 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1296 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1297 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1298 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1299 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1300 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1301
1302 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1303 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001304 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001305 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1306 made easily relocatable.
1307
1308 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1309 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1310 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1311 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1312 consistent across all configuration files.
1313
1314 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1315 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1316 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1317 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1318 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1319 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1320 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1321 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1322
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001323description <text>
1324 Add a text that describes the instance.
1325
1326 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1327 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1328 "<" and ">" characters.
1329
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001330deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1331 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001332 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001333
1334deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001335 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001336 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1337
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001338deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001339 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1340 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1341 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001342
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001343deviceatlas-separator <char>
1344 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1345 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1346
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001347expose-experimental-directives
1348 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1349 the config file will be rejected.
1350
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001351external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001352 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1353 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001354 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1355 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1356 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1357 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1358 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001359
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001360gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001361 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001362 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1363 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001364 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001365 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001366 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001367
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001368group <group name>
1369 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1370 See also "gid" and "user".
1371
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001372h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1373 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1374 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1375 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1376 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001377 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001378 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1379 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1380 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1381 specified in a proxy.
1382
1383 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1384 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1385 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1386 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1387 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1388 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1389 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1390
1391 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1392 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1393 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1394 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1395 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1396
1397 Example:
1398 global
1399 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1400
1401 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1402 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1403
1404h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1405 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1406 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1407 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1408 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1409 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1410 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1411 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1412 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1413
1414 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1415 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1416 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1417
1418 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1419 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1420
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001421h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1422 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1423 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1424 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1425 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1426 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1427 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1428 the keyword with "no'.
1429
1430hard-stop-after <time>
1431 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1432
1433 Arguments :
1434 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1435 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1436 SIGUSR1 signal.
1437
1438 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1439 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1440 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1441
1442 Example:
1443 global
1444 hard-stop-after 30s
1445
1446 See also: grace
1447
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001448insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001449 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001450 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1451 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1452 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1453 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1454 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1455 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1456 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001457 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001458 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1459 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1460 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1461 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1462 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1463 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1464 disable it.
1465
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001466insecure-setuid-wanted
1467 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1468 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1469 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1470 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001471 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001472 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001473 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001474 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1475 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001476 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001477 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1478 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1479 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1480 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1481
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001482issuers-chain-path <dir>
1483 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1484 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1485 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001486 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001487 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1488 "issuers-chain-path".
1489 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1490 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1491 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1492 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1493 will share the chain in memory.
1494
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001495localpeer <name>
1496 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1497 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1498 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1499 the configuration parsing.
1500
1501 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1502 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1503
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001504log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001505 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001506 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001507 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001508 configured with "log global".
1509
1510 <address> can be one of:
1511
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001512 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001513 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1514 port).
1515
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001516 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1517 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1518 port).
1519
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001520 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001521 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1522 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001523 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001524
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001525 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1526 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1527 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1528 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1529 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1530 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1531 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1532 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1533 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1534 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001535 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001536 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1537 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1538 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001539 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1540 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001541
1542 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1543 "fd@2", see above.
1544
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001545 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1546 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1547 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1548 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1549 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1550
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001551 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1552 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001553
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001554 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1555 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1556 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1557 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1558 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1559 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1560 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1561 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1562 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1563 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001564 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1565 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001566
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001567 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1568 one of the following :
1569
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001570 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1571 field is stripped. This is the default.
1572 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1573 rfc3164.
1574
1575 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001576 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1577
1578 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1579 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1580
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001581 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1582 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1583 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1584 designed to be used with a local log server.
1585
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001586 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1587 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1588 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1589 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1590 logger consumes.
1591
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001592 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1593 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1594 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1595 used with a local log server.
1596
1597 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1598 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1599 designed to be used with a local log server.
1600
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001601 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1602 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1603 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1604 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1605
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001606 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1607 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1608 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1609 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1610 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1611
1612 <sample_size>
1613 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1614 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1615 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1616 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1617 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1618
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001619 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001620
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001621 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1622 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1623 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1624
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001625 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1626 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1627 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1628 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001629
1630 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001631 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1632 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1633 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1634 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1635 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1636 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001637
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001638 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001639
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001640log-send-hostname [<string>]
1641 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1642 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1643 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1644 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1645 the logs.
1646
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001647log-tag <string>
1648 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1649 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1650 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001651 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001652
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001653lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001654 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1655 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1656 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1657 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1658 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1659 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001660 used multiple times.
1661
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001662lua-load-per-thread <file>
1663 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1664 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1665 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1666 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1667 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1668 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1669 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1670 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1671 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1672 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1673 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1674 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1675 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1676 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1677 times.
1678
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001679lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1680 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1681 variable.
1682 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1683 to "path".
1684
1685 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1686 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1687 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1688 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1689 will be checked earlier.
1690
1691 As an example by specifying the following path:
1692
1693 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1694 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1695
1696 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1697 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1698 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1699 paths if that does not exist either.
1700
1701 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1702 documentation.
1703
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001704master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001705 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1706 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1707 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001708 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001709 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1710 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001711 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1712 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1713 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1714 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1715 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001716
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001717 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001718
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001719mworker-max-reloads <number>
1720 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001721 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001722 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1723 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1724 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1725
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001726nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001727 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1728 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1729 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001730 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1731 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001732 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1733 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1734 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001735
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001736nbthread <number>
1737 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001738 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001739 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1740 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1741 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1742 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001743 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1744 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1745 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1746 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1747 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1748 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1749 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001750
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001751numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001752 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001753 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1754 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1755 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1756 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1757 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1758 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1759 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1760 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1761
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001762pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001763 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1764 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1765 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1766 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001767
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001768pp2-never-send-local
1769 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1770 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1771 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1772 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1773 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1774 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1775 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1776 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1777 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1778 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1779 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1780
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001781presetenv <name> <value>
1782 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1783 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1784 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1785 and "unsetenv".
1786
1787resetenv [<name> ...]
1788 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1789 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1790 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1791 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1792 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1793 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1794 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1795 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1796
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001797stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001798 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1799 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1800 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1801 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1802 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1803 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001804 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001805 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1806 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1807 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1808 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001809
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001810server-state-base <directory>
1811 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001812 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1813 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001814
1815server-state-file <file>
1816 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1817 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1818 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1819 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1820 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1821 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1822 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1823 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001824 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1825 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001826
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001827set-dumpable
1828 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1829 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1830 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1831 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1832 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1833 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1834 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1835 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1836 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1837 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1838 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1839 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1840 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1841 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1842 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1843 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1844 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
1845 leaves a core where expected when dying.
1846
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001847set-var <var-name> <expr>
1848 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1849 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1850 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1851 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1852 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1853 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1854 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1855 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1856 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1857
1858 Example:
1859 global
1860 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1861 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1862 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1863
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001864setenv <name> <value>
1865 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1866 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1867 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1868 and "unsetenv".
1869
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001870ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1872 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001873 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001874 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001875 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1876 information and recommendations see e.g.
1877 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1878 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1879 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1880 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001881
1882ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1883 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1884 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
William Lallemand6b0dea72024-03-11 15:48:14 +01001885 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1886 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1887 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1888 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1889 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1890 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. This setting might accept TLSv1.2
1891 ciphersuites however this is an undocumented behavior and not recommended as
1892 it could be inconsistent or buggy.
1893 The default TLSv1.3 ciphersuites of OpenSSL are:
1894 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
1895
1896 TLSv1.3 only supports 5 ciphersuites:
1897
1898 - TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
1899 - TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
1900 - TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256
1901 - TLS_AES_128_CCM_SHA256
1902 - TLS_AES_128_CCM_8_SHA256
1903
1904 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1905
1906 Example:
1907 global
1908 ssl-default-bind-ciphers ECDHE-RSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384:ECDHE-RSA-CHACHA20-POLY1305:ECDHE-RSA-AES128-GCM-SHA256
1909 ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001910
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001911ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1912 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1913 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1914 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1915 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1916 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1917
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001918ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1919 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1920 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1921 keyword to see available options.
1922
1923 Example:
1924 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001925 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001926
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001927ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1928 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1929 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001930 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001931 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001932 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1933 information and recommendations see e.g.
1934 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1935 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1936 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1937 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1938 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001939
1940ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
William Lallemand6b0dea72024-03-11 15:48:14 +01001942 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1943 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1944 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1945 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001946 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
William Lallemand6b0dea72024-03-11 15:48:14 +01001947 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1948 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1949 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001950
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001951ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1952 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1953 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1954 keyword to see available options.
1955
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001956ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1957 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1958 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1959 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001960 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001961 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001962 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1963 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1964 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1965 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001966 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1967 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1968 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1969
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001970ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1971 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1972 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001973 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001974 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001975 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1976
1977 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001978
1979 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1980 and won't try to remove them.
1981
1982 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1983
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001984ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001985 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001986 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1987 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1988 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001989
1990 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1991 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1992 optimize the startup time.
1993
1994 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1995 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1996 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1997
1998 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001999 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002000
2001 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002002 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2003 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002004
2005 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2006 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2007 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2008 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2009 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002010 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002011
2012 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002013 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002014 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2015 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2016 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2017 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2018 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002019 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002020
2021 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2022
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002023 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002024 a cert bundle.
2025
2026 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2027 separately in several "crt".
2028
2029 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2030 since files are loading separately.
2031
2032 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2033 required to commit them.
2034
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002035 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002036 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002037
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002038 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2039 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2040 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002041
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002042 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2043 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2044 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002045
2046 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002047 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2048 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002049
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002050 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2051 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2052
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002053 The default behavior is "all".
2054
2055 Example:
2056 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2057 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2058 ssl-load-extra-files none
2059
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002060 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2061 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002062
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002063ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2064 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2065 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2066 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2067
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002068ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002069 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002070 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2071 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2072 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2073 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2074 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2075 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002076 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002077
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002078stats maxconn <connections>
2079 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2080 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2081
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002082stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2083 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2084 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2085 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002086 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002087 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002088
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002089 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2090 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2091 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002092
2093stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2094 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2095 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002096 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002097
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002098strict-limits
2099 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2100 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2101 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2102 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2103 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002104
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002105uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002106 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002107 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2108 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2109 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2110
2111ulimit-n <number>
2112 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2113 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2114 option.
2115
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002116unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2117 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2118
2119 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2120 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2121 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2122 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2123 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002124 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002125 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2126 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2127 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2128 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2129
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002130unsetenv [<name> ...]
2131 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2132 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2133 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2134 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2135 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2136 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2137 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2138
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002139user <user name>
2140 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2141 See also "uid" and "group".
2142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002143node <name>
2144 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2145
2146 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2147 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2148 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2149 traffic.
2150
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002151wurfl-cache-size <size>
2152 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2153 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2154 - "0" : no cache is used.
2155 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002156
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002157 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2158 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002159
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002160wurfl-data-file <file path>
2161 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2162 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2163
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002164 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002165 with USE_WURFL=1.
2166
2167wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2168 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2169 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2170 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2171
2172 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2173
2174 Valid WURFL properties are:
2175 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2176
2177 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2178 device.
2179
2180 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2181 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2182
2183 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2184 particular web request.
2185
2186 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2187 used Libwurfl API version.
2188
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002189 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2190 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2191
2192 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2193 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2194
2195 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2196
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002197 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002198 with USE_WURFL=1.
2199
2200wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2201 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2202 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2203
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002204 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002205 with USE_WURFL=1.
2206
2207wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2208 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2209 thus before the chroot.
2210
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002211 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002212 with USE_WURFL=1.
2213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022143.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002215-----------------------
2216
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002217busy-polling
2218 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2219 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2220 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2221 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2222 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2223 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2224 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2225 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2226 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2227 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2228 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2229 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2230 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2231 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2232 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2233 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2234 "poll" pollers.
2235
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002236 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2237 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2238 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2239
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002240max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002241 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002242 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2243 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2244 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2245 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2246 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2247 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2248 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2249
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002250maxcompcpuusage <number>
2251 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2252 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2253 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2254 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2255 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2256 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2257 and from introducing high latencies.
2258
2259maxcomprate <number>
2260 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2261 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2262 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2263 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2264 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2265 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2266 default value.
2267
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002268maxconn <number>
2269 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2270 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2271 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002272 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2273 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2274 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2275 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002276 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2277 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2278 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2279 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2280 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2281 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002282
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002283maxconnrate <number>
2284 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2285 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2286 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2287 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2288 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2289 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2290 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2291 fairness.
2292
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002293maxpipes <number>
2294 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2295 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2296 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2297 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2298 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2299 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2300
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002301maxsessrate <number>
2302 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2303 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2304 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2305 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2306 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2307 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2308 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2309 fairness.
2310
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002311maxsslconn <number>
2312 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2313 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2314 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2315 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2316 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2317 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2318 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002319 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2320 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2321 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2322 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002323 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002324 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2325 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002326
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002327maxsslrate <number>
2328 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2329 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2330 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2331 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2332 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2333 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2334 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2335 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2336 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2337 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2338
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002339maxzlibmem <number>
2340 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2341 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2342 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002343 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2344 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2345 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2346
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002347no-memory-trimming
2348 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2349 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2350 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2351 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2352 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2353 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2354 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2355 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2356 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2357 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2358 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2359 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2360 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2361 not suffer from such a problem.
2362
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002363noepoll
2364 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2365 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002366 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002367
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002368noevports
2369 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2370 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2371 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2372 also "nopoll".
2373
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002374nogetaddrinfo
2375 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2376 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2377
2378nokqueue
2379 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2380 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2381 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2382
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002383nopoll
2384 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2385 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002386 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002387 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2388 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002389
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002390noreuseport
2391 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2392 command line argument "-dR".
2393
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002394nosplice
2395 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002396 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002397 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002398 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002399 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2400 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2401 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2402 "option splice-response".
2403
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002404profiling.memory { on | off }
2405 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2406 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2407 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2408 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2409 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2410 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2411 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2412 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2413 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2414
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002415profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2416 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2417 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2418 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2419 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002420 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002421 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2422 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2423 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2424 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2425
2426 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2427 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2428 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2429 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2430 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002431 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2432 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2433 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2434 CLI.
2435
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002436spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002437 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2438 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2439 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2440 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2441 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2442 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002443
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002444ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002445 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002446 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002447 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002448 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002449 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2450 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2451 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002452 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2453 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002454 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2455 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2456 openssl configuration file uses:
2457 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2458
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002459ssl-mode-async
2460 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002461 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002462 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2463 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002464 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002465 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002466 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002467
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002468tune.buffers.limit <number>
2469 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2470 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2471 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2472 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2473 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002474 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002475 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2476 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2477 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2478 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2479 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2480 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2481 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2482 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002483 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002484
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002485tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2486 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2487 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2488 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002489 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002490
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002491tune.bufsize <number>
2492 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2493 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2494 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2495 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2496 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2497 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2498 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002499 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2500 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002501 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002502 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002503 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002504 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2505 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002506
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002507tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2508 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002509
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002510tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2511 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2512 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2513 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2514 this value. The default value is 1.
2515
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002516tune.fail-alloc
2517 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2518 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2519 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2520 gracefully.
2521
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002522tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2523 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2524 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2525 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2526 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2527 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2528
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002529tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2530 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2531 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2532 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2533 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2534 change it.
2535
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002536tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2537 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002538 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002539 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002540 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2541 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2542 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2543 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2544 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2545
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002546tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2547 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2548 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2549 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2550 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2551 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002552 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002553 recommended not to change this value.
2554
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002555tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002556 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002557 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002558 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002559 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2560 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2561 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2562 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2563
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002564tune.http.cookielen <number>
2565 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2566 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2567 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2568 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2569 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2570 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2571 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2572 to change this value.
2573
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002574tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002575 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2576 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002577 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002578 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002579 configuration directives too.
2580 The default value is 1024.
2581
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002582tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2583 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2584 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2585 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2586 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2587 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2588 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002589 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2590 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2591 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002592
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002593tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2594 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2595 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2596 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2597 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2598 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2599 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002600 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2601 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2602 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2603 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2604 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002605
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002606tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002607 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002608 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2609 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2610 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2611 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002612 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002613 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002614 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002615 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2616
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002617tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2618 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2619 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2620 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2621 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2622 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2623 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2624 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2625 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2626 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2627
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002628tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2629 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002630 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002631 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2632 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002633 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002634 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2635 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2636
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002637tune.lua.maxmem
2638 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2639 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2640 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2641 memory.
2642
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002643tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2644 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002645 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2646 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002647 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002648
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002649tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2650 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2651 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2652 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002653 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002654
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002655tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2656 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2657 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2658 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2659 check servers.
2660
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002661tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002662 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2663 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002664 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2665 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2666 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2667 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2668 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2669 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2670 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2671 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2672 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002673
2674tune.maxpollevents <number>
2675 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2676 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2677 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2678 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2679 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2680
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002681tune.maxrewrite <number>
2682 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2683 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2684 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2685 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2686 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2687 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2688 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2689 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2690 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2691 bufsize.
2692
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002693tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2694 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2695 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2696 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2697 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2698 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2699 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2700 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2701 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2702 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002703 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2704 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002705 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2706 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2707 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2708 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2709 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2710 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2711 setting this parameter to 0.
2712
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002713tune.pipesize <number>
2714 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2715 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2716 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2717 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2718 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2719 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2720
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002721tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2722 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002723 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002724 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2725 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2726 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2727 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002728 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002729
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002730tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2731 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002732 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002733 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2734 default is 20.
2735
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002736tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2737tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2738 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2739 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2740 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002741 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002742 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002743 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2744 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2745
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002746tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002747 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002748 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2749 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2750 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2751 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2752
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002753tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002754 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002755 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2756 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2757 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2758 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2759 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2760 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2761 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002762
2763tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2764 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002765 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002766 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2767 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2768 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2769 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2770 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2771 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2772 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002773
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002774tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2775tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2776 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2777 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2778 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002779 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002780 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002781 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2782 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2783 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2784 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002785 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002786
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002787tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002788 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002789 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2790 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2791 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2792 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2793 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2794 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2795 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2796 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2797 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2798 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2799 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002800
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002801tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2802 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2803 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2804 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2805 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2806
2807tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2808 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2809 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2810 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2811 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2812 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
2813 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
2814 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
2815 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
2816 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
2817 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
2818 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
2819 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
2820
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002821tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002822 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002823 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2824 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2825 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2826 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2827 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2828
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002829tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2830 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2831 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2832 performances. This is disabled by default.
2833
2834 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2835 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2836
2837 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2838
2839 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2840
2841 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2842
2843 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2844 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2845 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2846
2847 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2848 converted.
2849
2850 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2851 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2852 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2853 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2854 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2855 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2856 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002857 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2858 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002859
2860 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2861
2862 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2863 only need this line:
2864
2865 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2866
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002867tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2868 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002869 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002870 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2871 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2872 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2873 being used for too long.
2874
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002875tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2876 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2877 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2878 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2879 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2880 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2881 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2882 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2883 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2884 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2885 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002886 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002887 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002888
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002889tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2890 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2891 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2892 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2893 1000 entries.
2894
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002895tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002896tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002897tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2898tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2899tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002900 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2901 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2902 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2903 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2904 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2905 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2906 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2907 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002908
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002909 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2910 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2911 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2912 all available space is consumed.
2913 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2914 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2915 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002916
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002917tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2918 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002919 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002920 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002921 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002922 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2923
2924tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2925 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2926 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002927 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2928 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029303.3. Debugging
2931--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002932
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002933quiet
2934 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2935 line argument "-q".
2936
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002937zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002938 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002939 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2940 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2941 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2942 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2943 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2944
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002945
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029463.4. Userlists
2947--------------
2948It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2949http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2950it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2951
2952userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002953 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002954 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2955
2956group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002957 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002958 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2959 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2960
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002961user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2962 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002963 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2964 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002965 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2966 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2967 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2968 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002969
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002970 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2971 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2972 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2973 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2974 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2975 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2976 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002977 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002978 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002979
2980 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002981 userlist L1
2982 group G1 users tiger,scott
2983 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002984
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002985 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2986 user scott insecure-password elgato
2987 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002988
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002989 userlist L2
2990 group G1
2991 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002992
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002993 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2994 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2995 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002996
2997 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002998
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002999
30003.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003001----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003002It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003003several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003004instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
3005values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
3006automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
3007In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
3008using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
3009tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
3010reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
3011Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3012that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3013each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003014
3015peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003016 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003017 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3018
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003019bind [<address>]:port [param*]
3020bind /<path> [param*]
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003021 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3022 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3023
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003024disabled
3025 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3026 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3027 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3028
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003029default-bind [param*]
3030 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3031
3032default-server [param*]
3033 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3034
3035 Arguments:
3036 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3037 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003038 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3039 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3040 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3041 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003042
3043 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3044
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003045enabled
3046 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3047 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003048
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003049log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003050 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3051 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3052 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3053 more details.
3054
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003055peer <peername> [<address>]:port [param*]
3056peer <peername> /<path> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003057 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3058 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003059 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003060 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on the provided
3061 address. Otherwise, the address defines where to connect to in order to join
3062 the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003063 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003064
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003065 During a soft restart, local peer address is used by the old instance to
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003066 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3067
3068 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003069 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3070 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3071 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003072
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003073 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3074 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003075
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003076 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3077 "server" keyword explanation below).
3078
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003079server <peername> [<address>:<port>] [param*]
3080server <peername> [/<path>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003081 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003082 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
Christopher Faulet23e69ae2023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003083 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, the address
3084 parameter must not be present; it must be provided on a "bind" line (see
3085 "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003086
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003087 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3088 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3089 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3090 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3091 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003092
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003093 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003094 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003095 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003096 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3097 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3098 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003099
3100 backend mybackend
3101 mode tcp
3102 balance roundrobin
3103 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3104 stick on src
3105
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003106 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3107 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003108
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003109 Example:
3110 peers mypeers
Emeric Brun6ca8ba42022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003111 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3112 default-server ssl verify none
3113 server haproxy1 #local peer
3114 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3115 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003116
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003117
3118table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3119 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3120
3121 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3122 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003123 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003124 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3125 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3126 "stick-table" keyword).
3127
3128 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3129 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3130 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3131 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3132 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3133 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3134 of the stick-table name as follows:
3135
3136 peers mypeers
3137 peer A ...
3138 peer B ...
3139 table t1 ...
3140
3141 frontend fe1
3142 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3143
3144 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3145 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3146
3147 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3148 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3149 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3150 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3151 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3152 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3153 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3154
3155 peers mypeers
3156 peer A ...
3157 peer B ...
3158 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3159
3160 backend t1
3161 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3162
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003163 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003164 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3165 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3166
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031673.6. Mailers
3168------------
3169It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3170If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3171in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3172
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003173mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003174 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3175 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3176
3177mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3178 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3179
3180 Example:
3181 mailers mymailers
3182 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3183 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3184
3185 backend mybackend
3186 mode tcp
3187 balance roundrobin
3188
3189 email-alert mailers mymailers
3190 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3191 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3192
3193 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3194 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3195
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003196timeout mail <time>
3197 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3198 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3199 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3200 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3201
3202 Example:
3203 mailers mymailers
3204 timeout mail 20s
3205 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003206
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020032073.7. Programs
3208-------------
3209In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3210master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3211managed the same way as the workers.
3212
3213During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3214sequence as a worker:
3215
3216 - the master is re-executed
3217 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3218 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3219 instance of the program
3220
3221During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3222
3223program <name>
3224 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3225 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3226 the management guide).
3227
3228command <command> [arguments*]
3229 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3230 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3231 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3232 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3233
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003234user <user name>
3235 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3236 See also "group".
3237
3238group <group name>
3239 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3240 See also "user".
3241
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003242option start-on-reload
3243no option start-on-reload
3244 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3245 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3246 program section.
3247
3248
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032493.8. HTTP-errors
3250----------------
3251
3252It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3253imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3254several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3255
3256http-errors <name>
3257 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3258 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3259
3260errorfile <code> <file>
3261 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3262
3263 Arguments :
3264 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003265 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003266 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003267
3268 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3269 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3270 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3271 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3272 before any chroot is performed.
3273
3274 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3275
3276 Example:
3277 http-errors website-1
3278 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3279 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3280 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3281
3282 http-errors website-2
3283 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3284 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3285 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3286
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032873.9. Rings
3288----------
3289
3290It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3291servers or traces.
3292
3293ring <ringname>
3294 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3295
3296description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003297 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003298 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3299
3300format <format>
3301 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3302
3303 Arguments:
3304 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3305 one of the following :
3306
3307 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3308 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3309 designed to be used with a local log server.
3310
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003311 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3312 field is stripped. This is the default.
3313 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3314 rfc3164.
3315
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003316 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3317 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3318 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3319 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3320 is the default.
3321
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003322 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003323 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3324
3325 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3326 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3327
3328 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3329 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3330 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3331 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3332 logger consumes.
3333
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003334 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3335 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3336 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3337 with a local log server.
3338
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003339 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3340 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3341 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3342 used with a local log server.
3343
3344maxlen <length>
3345 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3346 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3347 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3348
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003349server <name> <address> [param*]
3350 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3351 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3352 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3353 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3354 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3355 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3356 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3357 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3358 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003359 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3360 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003361
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003362size <size>
3363 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3364 set to BUFSIZE.
3365
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003366timeout connect <timeout>
3367 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3368
3369 Arguments :
3370 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3371 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3372 as explained at the top of this document.
3373
3374timeout server <timeout>
3375 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3376
3377 Arguments :
3378 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3379 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3380 as explained at the top of this document.
3381
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003382 Example:
3383 global
3384 log ring@myring local7
3385
3386 ring myring
3387 description "My local buffer"
3388 format rfc3164
3389 maxlen 1200
3390 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003391 timeout connect 5s
3392 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003393 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003394
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033953.10. Log forwarding
3396-------------------
3397
3398It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003399HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003400
3401log-forward <name>
3402 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3403
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003404backlog <conns>
3405 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3406 on connections accept.
3407
3408bind <addr> [param*]
3409 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003410 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3411 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3412 syslog protocol over TCP.
3413 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003414 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3415
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003416dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003417 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3418 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3419 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3420 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003421 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003422
3423log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003424log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003425 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3426 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3427 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003428 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003429 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3430 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3431 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003432 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003433
3434 Example:
3435 global
3436 log stderr format iso local7
3437
3438 ring myring
3439 description "My local buffer"
3440 format rfc5424
3441 maxlen 1200
3442 size 32764
3443 timeout connect 5s
3444 timeout server 10s
3445 # syslog tcp server
3446 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3447
3448 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003449 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3450 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003451 # all messages on stderr
3452 log global
3453 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3454 log ring@myring local0
3455 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3456 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3457 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3458 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3459 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003460
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003461maxconn <conns>
3462 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3463 10 is the default.
3464
3465timeout client <timeout>
3466 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034684. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003469----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003470
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003471Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003472 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3473 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3474 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3475 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003476
3477A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3478connections.
3479
3480A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3481to forward incoming connections.
3482
3483A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3484parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3485
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003486A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3487ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3488sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3489the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3490explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3491from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3492"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3493for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3494to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3495optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3496are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3497any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3498names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3499that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3500duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3501names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3502
3503Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3504settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3505of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3506profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3507timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3508
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003509All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3510'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3511case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3512
3513Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3514logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3515proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3516However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3517name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3518
3519Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3520and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003521bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003522protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3523modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3524arbitrary criteria.
3525
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003526In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3527a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003528the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003529
3530 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3531 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3532 between responses and new requests.
3533
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003534 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3535 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3536 client-facing connection remains open.
3537
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003538 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3539 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003540
3541The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3542frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3543following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003544weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003545
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003546 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003547
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003548 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3549 ----+-----+-----+----
3550 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3551 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003552 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3553 ----+-----+-----+----
3554 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003555
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003556It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003557only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3558within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003559as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003560content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003561and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3562possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003563
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003564There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003565first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003566processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003567second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003568protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3569is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3570new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003571to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003572process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3573already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3574HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3575evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3576one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3577
3578There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3579performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3580tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3581preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3582analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3583HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3584header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3585mitigate this drawback.
3586
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003587There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003588method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3589set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3590in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3591is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3592to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3593above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3594to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3595"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3596frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3597frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3598as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3599upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3600on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3601the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3602upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3603frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3604remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020036064.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3607--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003609The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3610limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3611they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3612limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003613marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003614option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003615and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3616with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3617specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003618
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003619
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003620 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3621------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3622acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003623backlog X X X -
3624balance X - X X
3625bind - X X -
3626bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003627capture cookie - X X -
3628capture request header - X X -
3629capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003630clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3631clitcpka-idle X X X -
3632clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003633compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003634cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003635declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003636default-server X - X X
3637default_backend X X X -
3638description - X X X
3639disabled X X X X
3640dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003641email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003642email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003643email-alert mailers X X X X
3644email-alert myhostname X X X X
3645email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003646enabled X X X X
3647errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003648errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003649errorloc X X X X
3650errorloc302 X X X X
3651-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3652errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003653force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003654filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003655fullconn X - X X
3656grace X X X X
3657hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003658http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003659http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003660http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003661http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003662http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003663http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003664http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003665http-check set-var X - X X
3666http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003667http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003668http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003669http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003670http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGON17e3cd52023-01-12 15:59:27 +01003671http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003672id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003673ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003674load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003675log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003676log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003677log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003678log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003679max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGON59f36bc2023-11-29 10:13:18 +01003680max-session-srv-conns X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003681maxconn X X X -
3682mode X X X X
3683monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003684monitor-uri X X X -
3685option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3686option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3687option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3688option allbackups (*) X - X X
3689option checkcache (*) X - X X
3690option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3691option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003692option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003693option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3694option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003695-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3696option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003697option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3698option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003699option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003700option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003701option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003702option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003703option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003704option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003705option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3706option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3707option httpchk X - X X
3708option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003709option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003710option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003711option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003712option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003713option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003714option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3715option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3716option logasap (*) X X X -
3717option mysql-check X - X X
3718option nolinger (*) X X X X
3719option originalto X X X X
3720option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003721option pgsql-check X - X X
3722option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003723option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003724option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003725option smtpchk X - X X
3726option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3727option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3728option splice-request (*) X X X X
3729option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGON54832622023-01-12 15:06:11 +01003730option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003731option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3732option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3733-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003734option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003735option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3736option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3737option tcpka X X X X
3738option tcplog X X X X
3739option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003740option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003741external-check command X - X X
3742external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003743persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3744rate-limit sessions X X X -
3745redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003746-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003747retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003748retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003749server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003750server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003751server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003752source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003753srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3754srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3755srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003756stats admin - X X X
3757stats auth X X X X
3758stats enable X X X X
3759stats hide-version X X X X
3760stats http-request - X X X
3761stats realm X X X X
3762stats refresh X X X X
3763stats scope X X X X
3764stats show-desc X X X X
3765stats show-legends X X X X
3766stats show-node X X X X
3767stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003768-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3769stick match - - X X
3770stick on - - X X
3771stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003772stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003773stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003774tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003775tcp-check connect X - X X
3776tcp-check expect X - X X
3777tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003778tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003779tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003780tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003781tcp-check set-var X - X X
3782tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003783tcp-request connection - X X -
3784tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003785tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003786tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003787tcp-response content - - X X
3788tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003789timeout check X - X X
3790timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003791timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003792timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003793timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3794timeout http-request X X X X
3795timeout queue X - X X
3796timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003797timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003798timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003799timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003800transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003801unique-id-format X X X -
3802unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003803use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003804use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003805use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003806------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3807 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003808
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020038104.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3811---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003812
3813This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3814
3815
3816acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3817 Declare or complete an access list.
3818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3819 no | yes | yes | yes
3820 Example:
3821 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3822 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3823 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003825 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003826
3827
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003828backlog <conns>
3829 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3831 yes | yes | yes | no
3832 Arguments :
3833 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3834 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003835 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003836
3837 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3838 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3839 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3840 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3841 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3842 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3843 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3844 backlog parameter.
3845
3846 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3847 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3848 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3849
3850 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3851
3852
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003853balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003854balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003855 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3857 yes | no | yes | yes
3858 Arguments :
3859 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3860 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3861 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3862 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3863
3864 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3865 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3866 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3867 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003868 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003869 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003870 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3871 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3872 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3873 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3874 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3875 it, so that you don't worry.
3876
3877 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3878 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3879 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3880 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3881 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3882 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3883 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3884 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003885
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003886 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3887 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3888 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3889 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3890 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3891 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3892 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003893 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3894 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3895 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003896
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003897 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003898 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003899 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3900 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003901 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003902 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3903 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3904 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3905 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3906 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003907 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3908 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3909 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3910 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3911 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3912 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003913
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003914 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3915 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3916 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3917 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3918 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3919 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3920 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3921 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003922 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003923 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003924 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3925 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3926 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003927
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003928 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3929 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3930 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3931 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3932 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3933 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3934 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3935 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3936 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3937 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3938 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3939 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003940
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003941 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003942 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3943 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3944 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3945 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3946 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3947 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3948 URIs start with a leading "/".
3949
3950 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3951 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3952 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3953 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3954
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003955 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3956 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3957 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3958 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3959
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003960 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003961 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3962
3963 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003964 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3965 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003966 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3967 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3968 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3969 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003970 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003971 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3972 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003973
3974 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3975 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3976 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3977 server will receive the request.
3978
3979 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3980 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3981 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3982 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3983 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003984 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3985 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3986 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003987
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003988 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3989 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3990 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3991 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3992 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003994 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003995 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3996 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3997 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3998
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003999 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4000 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4001 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4002
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004003 random
4004 random(<draws>)
4005 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004006 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4007 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4008 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4009 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004010 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4011 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4012 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4013 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4014 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4015 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4016 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4017 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4018 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4019 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4020 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4021 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4022 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4023 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4024 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4025 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4026 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4027 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4028 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4029 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004030
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004031 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004032 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004033 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4034 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004035 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004036 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4037 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4038 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004039 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004040 used instead.
4041
4042 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4043 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4044 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004045 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004046
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004047 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4048 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4049 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4050
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004051 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004052 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4053 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004054
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004055 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4056 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4057 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004058
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004059 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004060 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004061 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4062 NTLM relies on.
4063
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004064 Examples :
4065 balance roundrobin
4066 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004067 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004068 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4069 balance hdr(host)
4070 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004071
4072 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4073 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4074
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004075 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004076 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4077 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4078 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004079 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004080
4081 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4082 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4083 defaults to 16 kB.
4084
4085 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4086 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4087
4088 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4089 Round Robin.
4090
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004091 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004092 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4093 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4094 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4095
4096 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4097
4098 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004099 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004100 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4101 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4102 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004103
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004104 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004105
4106
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004107bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4108bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004109 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4111 no | yes | yes | no
4112 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004113 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4114 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4115 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4116 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004117 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004118 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4119 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4120 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4121 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4122 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4123 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004124 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004125 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4126 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004127 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004128 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4129 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004130 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004131 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4132 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004133 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004134 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4135 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4136 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4137 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4138 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4139 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4140 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004141 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4142 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4143 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004144 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4145 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4146 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4147 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004148 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4149 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4150 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004151
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004152 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4153 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004154 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4155 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4156 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004157 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4158 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4159 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4160 the range.
4161
4162 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4163 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4164 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4165 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4166 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4167 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4168 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004169 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004170 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004171
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004172 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004173 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004174 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4175 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4176 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4177 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4178 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4179 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4180
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004181 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4182 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4183 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4184 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004185
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004186 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4187 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4188 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4189 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4190 in a frontend.
4191
4192 Example :
4193 listen http_proxy
4194 bind :80,:443
4195 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004196 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004197
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004198 listen http_https_proxy
4199 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004200 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004201
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004202 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4203 bind ipv6@:80
4204 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4205 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4206
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004207 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004208 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004209
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004210 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4211 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4212 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4213 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4214 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4215
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004216 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004217 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004218
4219
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004220bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004221 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4223 yes | yes | yes | yes
4224 Arguments :
4225 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4226 may be used to override a default value.
4227
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004228 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004229 option may be combined with other numbers.
4230
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004231 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004232 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4233 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4234 missing from all processes.
4235
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004236 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004237 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004238 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4239 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4240 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4241 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4242 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004243 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004244
4245 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4246 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4247 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4248 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4249 and 'even' instances.
4250
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004251 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4252 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4253 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4254 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004255
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004256 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4257 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4258
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004259 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4260 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4261 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4262
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004263 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4264 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4265
4266 Example :
4267 listen app_ip1
4268 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004269 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004270
4271 listen app_ip2
4272 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004273 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004274
4275 listen management
4276 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004277 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004278
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004279 listen management
4280 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4281 bind-process 1-4
4282
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004283 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004284
4285
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004286capture cookie <name> len <length>
4287 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4289 no | yes | yes | no
4290 Arguments :
4291 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4292 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4293 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4294 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004295 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004296
4297 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4298 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4299 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4300 right if it exceeds <length>.
4301
4302 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4303 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4304 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4305 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4306
4307 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4308 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4309 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4310
4311 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4312 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4313 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004314 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4315 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4316 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004317
4318 Example:
4319 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4320
4321 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004322 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004323
4324
4325capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004326 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4328 no | yes | yes | no
4329 Arguments :
4330 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004331 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004332 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4333 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4334 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4335
4336 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4337 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4338 it exceeds <length>.
4339
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004340 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004341 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4342 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004343 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4344 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4345 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4346 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004347 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004348 environments to find where the request came from.
4349
4350 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4351 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4352 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4353 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004354
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004355 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4356 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4357 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4358 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4359 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004360
4361 Example:
4362 capture request header Host len 15
4363 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004364 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004366 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004367 about logging.
4368
4369
4370capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004371 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4373 no | yes | yes | no
4374 Arguments :
4375 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004376 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004377 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4378 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4379 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4380
4381 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4382 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4383 it exceeds <length>.
4384
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004385 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004386 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4387 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4388 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004389 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4390 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4391 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4392 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004393
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004394 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4395 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4396 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4397 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4398 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004399
4400 Example:
4401 capture response header Content-length len 9
4402 capture response header Location len 15
4403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004404 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004405 about logging.
4406
4407
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004408clitcpka-cnt <count>
4409 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4410 the connection on the client side.
4411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4412 yes | yes | yes | no
4413 Arguments :
4414 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4415
4416 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4417 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004418 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4419 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004420
4421 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4422
4423
4424clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4425 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4426 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4427 client side.
4428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4429 yes | yes | yes | no
4430 Arguments :
4431 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4432 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4433 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4434 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4435
4436 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4437 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004438 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4439 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004440
4441 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4442
4443
4444clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4445 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4447 yes | yes | yes | no
4448 Arguments :
4449 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4450 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4451 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4452 document.
4453
4454 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4455 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004456 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4457 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004458
4459 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4460
4461
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004462compression algo <algorithm> ...
4463compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004464compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004465 Enable HTTP compression.
4466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4467 yes | yes | yes | yes
4468 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004469 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4470 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004471 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004472
4473 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004474 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4475 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4476 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004477
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004478 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004479 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004480
4481 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4482 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4483 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4484 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4485 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004486 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004487
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004488 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4489 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4490 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4491 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4492 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4493 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4494 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004495 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004496
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004497 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004498 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004499 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004500 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004501 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004502 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004503 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004504
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004505 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004506 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4507 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004508 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4509 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004510 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004511 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004512 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4513 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004514 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004515 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4516 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004517
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004518 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004519 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4520 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004521 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004522 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004523 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4524 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4525 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4526 "multipart"
4527 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4528 header
4529 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4530 and later
4531 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4532 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004533 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004534
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004535 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004536
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004537 Examples :
4538 compression algo gzip
4539 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004540
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004541
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004542cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004543 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4544 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004545 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004546 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4548 yes | no | yes | yes
4549 Arguments :
4550 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4551 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4552 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4553 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4554 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4555 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004556 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004557 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4558 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4559
4560 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004561 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004562 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4563 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4564 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4565 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004566 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4567 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004568 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004569 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4570 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004571
4572 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004573 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004574
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004575 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004576 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004577 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004578 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004579 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4580 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4581 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4582 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4583 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4584 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4585 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004586
4587 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4588 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4589 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4590 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4591 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4592 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4593 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4594 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4595 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004596 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004597 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4598 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4599 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004600
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004601 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4602 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4603 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004604 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4605 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4606 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4607 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004608 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4609 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4610 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004611
4612 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4613 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4614 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4615 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4616 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4617 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4618 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4619 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4620 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4621
4622 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4623 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4624 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4625 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4626 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4627 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4628 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4629 persistence cookie in the cache.
4630 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4631
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004632 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4633 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004634 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004635 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4636 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004637 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004638 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4639 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4640 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4641 they logout.
4642
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004643 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004644 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4645 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4646 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4647
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004648 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004649 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4650 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4651 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4652 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4653 this attribute.
4654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004655 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004656 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004657 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4658 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4659 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4660 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4661 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4662 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004663
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004664 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4665 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4666 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4667 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4668 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4669 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4670 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4671 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004672 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004673 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4674 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4675 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4676 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4677 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4678 the site.
4679
4680 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4681 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4682 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4683 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4684 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4685 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4686 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4687 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4688 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4689 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4690 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4691 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4692 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004693 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004694 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4695 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4696
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004697 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4698 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4699 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4700 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4701 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4702 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4703
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004704 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004705 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4706 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4707 repeated.
4708
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004709 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4710 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4711 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4712 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004713
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004714 Examples :
4715 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4716 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4717 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004718 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004719
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004720 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004721
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004722
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004723declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4724 Declares a capture slot.
4725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4726 no | yes | yes | no
4727 Arguments:
4728 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4729
4730 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4731 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4732 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4733 for use in the response.
4734
4735 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004736 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004737 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4738
4739
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004740default-server [param*]
4741 Change default options for a server in a backend
4742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4743 yes | no | yes | yes
4744 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004745 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4746 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4747 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4748 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004749
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004750 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004751 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4752
4753 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004754
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004755
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004756default_backend <backend>
4757 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4759 yes | yes | yes | no
4760 Arguments :
4761 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4762
4763 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4764 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4765 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4766 will catch all undetermined requests.
4767
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004768 Example :
4769
4770 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4771 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4772 default_backend dynamic
4773
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004774 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004775
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004776
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004777description <string>
4778 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4780 no | yes | yes | yes
4781 Arguments : string
4782
4783 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4784 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4785 it describes.
4786 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4787
4788
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004789disabled
4790 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4792 yes | yes | yes | yes
4793 Arguments : none
4794
4795 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4796 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4797 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4798 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4799 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4800 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4801 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4802
4803 See also : "enabled"
4804
4805
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004806dispatch <address>:<port>
4807 Set a default server address
4808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4809 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004810 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004811
4812 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4813 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4814 during start-up.
4815
4816 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4817 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4818 possible with normal servers.
4819
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004820 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004821 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4822 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4823 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4824 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4825
4826 See also : "server"
4827
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004828
4829dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4830 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4832 yes | no | yes | yes
4833 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4834
4835 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004836 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004837 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4838 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004839 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004840 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004841
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004842enabled
4843 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4845 yes | yes | yes | yes
4846 Arguments : none
4847
4848 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4849 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4850
4851 See also : "disabled"
4852
4853
4854errorfile <code> <file>
4855 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4857 yes | yes | yes | yes
4858 Arguments :
4859 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004860 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004861 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004862
4863 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004864 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004865 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004866 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4867 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004868
4869 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4870 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4871 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4872
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004873 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4874
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004875 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4876 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4877 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4878 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4879 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4880 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4881 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4882 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4883 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004884
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004885 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4886 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4887 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004888 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004889 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4890
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004891 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004892
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004893 Example :
4894 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004895 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004896 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4897 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4898
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004899
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004900errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4901 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4902 section.
4903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4904 yes | yes | yes | yes
4905 Arguments :
4906 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4907
4908 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004909 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004910 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4911 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004912
4913 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4914 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4915 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4916 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4917 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004918 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004919 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4920
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004921 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4922 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004923
4924 Example :
4925 errorfiles generic
4926 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4927
4928
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004929errorloc <code> <url>
4930errorloc302 <code> <url>
4931 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4933 yes | yes | yes | yes
4934 Arguments :
4935 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004936 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004937 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004938
4939 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4940 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4941 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4942 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004943 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004944
4945 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4946 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4947 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4948
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004949 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4950
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004951 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4952 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4953 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4954 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004955 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004956 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4957 request.
4958
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004959 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004960
4961
4962errorloc303 <code> <url>
4963 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4965 yes | yes | yes | yes
4966 Arguments :
4967 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004968 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004969 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004970
4971 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4972 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4973 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4974 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004975 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004976
4977 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4978 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4979 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4980
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004981 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4982
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004983 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4984 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4985 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4986 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004987 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004988
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004989 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004990
4991
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004992email-alert from <emailaddr>
4993 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004994 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004995 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4996 yes | yes | yes | yes
4997
4998 Arguments :
4999
5000 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5001
5002 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5003 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5004
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005005 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005006 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5007 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005008
5009
5010email-alert level <level>
5011 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5012 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5013 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5014 yes | yes | yes | yes
5015
5016 Arguments :
5017
5018 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5019 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5020 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5021
5022 By default level is alert
5023
5024 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5025 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5026 for the proxy.
5027
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005028 Alerts are sent when :
5029
5030 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5031 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5032 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5033 is notice or lower
5034 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5035 and a health check status update occurs
5036
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005037 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5038 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005039 section 3.6 about mailers.
5040
5041
5042email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5043 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5044 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5045 yes | yes | yes | yes
5046
5047 Arguments :
5048
5049 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5050
5051 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5052 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5053
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005054 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5055 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005056
5057
5058email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5059 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5060 mailers.
5061 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5062 yes | yes | yes | yes
5063
5064 Arguments :
5065
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005066 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005067
5068 By default the systems hostname is used.
5069
5070 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5071 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5072 for the proxy.
5073
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005074 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5075 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005076
5077
5078email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005079 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005080 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5081 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5082 yes | yes | yes | yes
5083
5084 Arguments :
5085
5086 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5087
5088 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5089 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5090
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005091 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005092 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5093
5094
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005095force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5096 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5097 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005098 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005099
5100 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5101 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5102 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5103 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5104 marked down for maintenance operations.
5105
5106 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5107 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5108 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5109 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5110 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5111 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5112 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5113 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5114 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5115
5116 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5117 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5118 is used.
5119
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005120 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005121 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005122
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005123
5124filter <name> [param*]
5125 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5127 no | yes | yes | yes
5128 Arguments :
5129 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5130 referenced in section 9.
5131
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005132 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005133 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005134 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5135 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005136
5137 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5138 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5139
5140 Example:
5141 listen
5142 bind *:80
5143
5144 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5145 filter compression
5146 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5147
5148 compression algo gzip
5149 compression offload
5150
5151 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5152
5153 See also : section 9.
5154
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005155
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005156fullconn <conns>
5157 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5159 yes | no | yes | yes
5160 Arguments :
5161 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5162 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5163
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005164 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005165 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005166 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005167 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5168 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5169 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5170 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5171 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005172 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005173
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005174 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005175 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005176 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5177 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5178 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005179
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005180 Example :
5181 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5182 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5183 # connections.
5184 backend dynamic
5185 fullconn 10000
5186 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5187 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5188
5189 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5190
5191
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005192grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005193 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005195 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005196 Arguments :
5197 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5198 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5199 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5200
5201 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5202 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005203 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005204 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5205
5206 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5207 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5208 simplify it.
5209
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005210
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005211hash-balance-factor <factor>
5212 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5214 yes | no | no | yes
5215 Arguments :
5216 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5217 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005218 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005219
5220 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5221 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5222 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5223 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5224 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5225 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5226 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5227
5228 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5229 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5230 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5231 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5232 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5233
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005234 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5235 consistent hashing mechanism.
5236
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005237 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5238
5239
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005240hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005241 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5243 yes | no | yes | yes
5244 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005245 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5246 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005247
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005248 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5249 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5250 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5251 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5252 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5253 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5254 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5255 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5256 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5257 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005258
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005259 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5260 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5261 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5262 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5263 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5264 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5265 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5266 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5267 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5268 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5269 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5270 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5271 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005272 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5273 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005274
5275 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5276
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005277 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005278 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5279 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5280 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005281 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5282 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5283 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005284
5285 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5286 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005287 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5288 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5289 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5290 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5291
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005292 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005293 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5294 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5295 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5296 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5297 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5298 parameter.
5299
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005300 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5301 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5302 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5303 used on strings.
5304
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005305 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5306
5307 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5308 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5309 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5310 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5311 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5312 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5313 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5314 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5315 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5316 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5317 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5318 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005319
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005320 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5321 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5322 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005323
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005324 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005325
5326
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005327http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5328 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5329 ones).
5330
5331 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5332 no | yes | yes | yes
5333
5334 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5335 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5336 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5337 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5338 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5339 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5340
5341 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5342 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5343 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5344
5345 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5346 below.
5347
5348 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5349 instance.
5350
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005351 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5352 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5353 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5354
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005355 Example:
5356 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5357 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5358 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5359
5360http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5361
5362 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5363 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5364 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5365 example, or to pass some internal information.
5366 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5367 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5368 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5369
5370http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5371
5372 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5373 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5374
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005375http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005376
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005377 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5378 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5379 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5380 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5381 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005382
5383http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5384 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5385
5386 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5387
5388 Example:
5389 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5390
5391 # applied to:
5392 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5393
5394 # outputs:
5395 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5396
5397 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5398
5399http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5400 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5401
5402 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5403
5404 Example:
5405 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5406
5407 # applied to:
5408 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5409
5410 # outputs:
5411 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5412
5413http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5414
5415 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5416 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5417 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5418
5419http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5420 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5421
5422 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5423 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5424 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5425 fallback.
5426
5427 Example:
5428 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5429 http-response set-status 431
5430 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5431 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5432
5433http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5434
5435 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5436 inline.
5437
5438 Arguments:
5439 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5440 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5441 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5442 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5443 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5444 (request and response)
5445 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5446 processing
5447 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5448 processing
5449 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5450 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5451 and '_'.
5452
5453 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5454 followed by some converters.
5455
5456 Example:
5457 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5458
5459http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5460
5461 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5462 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5463 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5464 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5465 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005466 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005467 processing.
5468
5469 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5470 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005471 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005472 rules evaluation.
5473
5474http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5475
5476 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5477 details about <var-name>.
5478
5479 Example:
5480 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5481
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005482
5483http-check comment <string>
5484 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5485 it fails.
5486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5487 yes | no | yes | yes
5488
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005489 Arguments :
5490 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5491 rule fails.
5492
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005493 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5494 user-friendly error reporting.
5495
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005496 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005497 "http-check expect".
5498
5499
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005500http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5501 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005502 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005503 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5505 yes | no | yes | yes
5506
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005507 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005508 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5509
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005510 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005511 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005512
5513 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5514 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5515 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5516 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5517
5518 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5519
5520 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5521
5522 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5523
5524 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5525
5526 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5527
5528 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5529 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5530 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5531 is used.
5532
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005533 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5534 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5535 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5536 haproxy -vv.
5537
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005538 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5539
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005540 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5541 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5542 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5543 different ports or with different servers.
5544
5545 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5546 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5547 the port with a "http-check connect".
5548
5549 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5550 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5551 do.
5552
5553 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5554 unset-var or comment rules.
5555
5556 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005557 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5558 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5559 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5560 option httpchk
5561
5562 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005563 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005564 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005565 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005566 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005567 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005568
5569 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5570
5571 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005572
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005574http-check disable-on-404
5575 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005577 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005578 Arguments : none
5579
5580 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5581 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5582 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5583 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5584 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5585 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5586 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5587 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005588 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5589 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005590 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5591 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5592 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005593
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005594 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005595
5596
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005597http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005598 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5599 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5600 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005601 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005603 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005604
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005605 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005606 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5607
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005608 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5609 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5610 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5611 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5612 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5613 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5614 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5615 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5616 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5617 result is always conclusive.
5618
5619 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5620 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5621 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005622 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5623 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005624 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5625 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005626 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5627 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5628 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005629
5630 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5631 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005632 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5633 supported :
5634 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5635 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005636 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5637 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5638 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5639 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5640 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005641
5642 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5643 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005644 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5645 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5646 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5647 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005648 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5649
5650 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5651 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5652 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5653 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5654
5655 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5656 informational message reported in logs if an error
5657 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5658 log-format string.
5659
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005660 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005661 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5662 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005663 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5664 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5665 details on the supported keywords.
5666
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005667 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5668 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5669 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5670 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005671
5672 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5673 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5674 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5675 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5676 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5677
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005678 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5679 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5680 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5681 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5682 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5683 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5684 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005685
5686 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005687 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005688 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5689 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5690 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5691 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5692
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005693 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5694 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005695 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5696 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5697 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5698 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5699 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5700 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5701 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5702 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005703 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5704 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5705 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5706 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5707 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5708 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5709 insensitive on the header names.
5710
5711 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5712 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5713 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5714 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5715 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5716 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005717
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005718 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005719 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005720 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5721 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5722 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5723 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5724 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005725 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005726 trace).
5727
5728 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005729 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005730 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5731 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5732 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5733 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5734 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005735 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005736
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005737 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5738 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5739 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5740 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5741 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5742 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5743
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005744 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005745 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005746 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5747 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5748 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5749 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5750 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5751 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5752
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005753 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5754 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5755 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5756 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5757 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005758
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005759 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5760 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5761
5762 Examples :
5763 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005764 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005765
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005766 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5767 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5768
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005769 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005770 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005771
5772 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005773 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005774
5775 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005776 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005777
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005778 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005779 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005780
5781
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005782http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005783 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5784 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005785 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5786 health checks.
5787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5788 yes | no | yes | yes
5789 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005790 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5791
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005792 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5793 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5794 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5795 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5796 to invent non-standard ones.
5797
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005798 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5799 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5800 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5801 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5802
5803 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5804 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5805 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5806 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005807
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005808 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005809 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005810 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005811 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5812 to add it.
5813
5814 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5815 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5816 to the log-format rules.
5817
5818 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5819 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5820 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005821
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005822 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5823 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5824 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5825 request.
5826
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005827 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5828 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5829 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005830 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5831 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5832 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5833 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005834 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005835
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005836 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005837 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5838 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005839
5840 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5841 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5842 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5843 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5844 configured request authority.
5845
5846 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5847 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005848
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005849 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005850
5851
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005852http-check send-state
5853 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5855 yes | no | yes | yes
5856 Arguments : none
5857
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005858 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005859 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005860 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5861 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5862 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005863
5864 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5865 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5866 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5867 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5868 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005869 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5870 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5871 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5872
5873 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5874 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5875 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5876
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005877 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5878 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5879 checked in multiple backends.
5880
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005881 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005882 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5883
5884 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5885 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5886 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5887 one fails.
5888
5889 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5890 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5891 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5892
5893 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5894 server's queue.
5895
5896 Example of a header received by the application server :
5897 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5898 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5899
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005900 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5901 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005902
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005903
5904http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005905 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005906 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5907 yes | no | yes | yes
5908
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005909 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005910 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5911 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5912 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5913 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5914 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5915 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5916 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5917 and '-'.
5918
5919 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5920
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005921 Examples :
5922 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005923
5924
5925http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005926 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005927 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5928 yes | no | yes | yes
5929
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005930 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005931 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5932 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5933 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5934 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5935 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5936 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5937 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5938 and '-'.
5939
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005940 Examples :
5941 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005942
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005943
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005944http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5945 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5946 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5947 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5948 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5950 yes | yes | yes | yes
5951 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005952 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005953 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005954 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005955 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005956
5957 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5958 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5959 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5960 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5961
5962 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5963 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5964 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5965 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5966
5967 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5968 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5969 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5970 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5971 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5972 chroot is performed.
5973
5974 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5975 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5976 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5977 considered.
5978
5979 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5980 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5981 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5982 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5983 considered as a raw string.
5984
5985 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5986 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5987 "content-type".
5988
5989 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5990 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5991 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5992 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5993 evaluated as a log-format string.
5994
5995 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5996 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5997 argument to "content-type".
5998
5999 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6000 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6001 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6002 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6003
6004 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6005 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6006 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6007 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6008 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6009 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6010 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6011 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6012
6013 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6014 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6015 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6016
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006017 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6018 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6019 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6020 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6021 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6022
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006023 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6024 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6025
6026
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006027http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006028 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6029
6030 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6031 no | yes | yes | yes
6032
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006033 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6034 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6035 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6036 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6037 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006038
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006039 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6040 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006042 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006044 Example:
6045 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6046 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6047 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006049 http-request allow if nagios
6050 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6051 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6052 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006054 Example:
6055 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6056 acl add path /addacl
6057 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006058
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006059 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006060
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006061 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6062 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006063
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006064 Example:
6065 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6066 acl setmap path /setmap
6067 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006068
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006069 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006071 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6072 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006073
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006074 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6075 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006076
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006077http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006078
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006079 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6080 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6081 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6082 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6083 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6084 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6085 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6086 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006087
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006088http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006089
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006090 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6091 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6092 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6093 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6094 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6095 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6096 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6097 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006098
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006099http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006100
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006101 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6102 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006103
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006104
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006105http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006106
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006107 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6108 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6109 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6110 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6111 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006112
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006113 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6114 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6115 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6116 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6117 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6118 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6119 instead.
6120
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006121 Example:
6122 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6123 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006124
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006125http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006126
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006127 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006129http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6130 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006131
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006132 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6133 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6134 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6135 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6136 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6137 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6138 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6139 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6140 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006141
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006142 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6143 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6144 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006145 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6146
6147 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6148 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6149 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6150 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006151
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006152http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006154 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6155 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6156 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6157 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6158 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6159 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006160
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006161http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006162
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006163 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6164 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6165 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6166 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6167 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006168
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006169http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006170
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006171 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6172 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6173 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6174 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6175 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6176 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006177
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006178http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6179http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6180 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6181 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6182 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6183 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006184
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006185 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6186 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6187 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006188 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006189 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6190 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6191 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006192 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006193 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006194
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006195http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6196 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6197 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6198 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6199
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006200http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6201
6202 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6203 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6204 pointed by <resolvers>.
6205 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6206 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6207 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6208 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6209 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6210 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6211 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6212 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6213 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6214 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006215 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6216 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006217
6218 Example:
6219 resolvers mydns
6220 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6221 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6222 timeout retry 1s
6223 hold valid 10s
6224 hold nx 3s
6225 hold other 3s
6226 hold obsolete 0s
6227 accepted_payload_size 8192
6228
6229 frontend fe
6230 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006231 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower,regsub(:[0-9]*$,)
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006232 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6233
6234 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6235 # which mean DNS resolution error
6236 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6237
6238 default_backend be
6239
6240 backend b_503
6241 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6242 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6243 # 503 error page to end users
6244
6245 backend be
6246 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6247 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6248 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6249 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6250 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6251
6252 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6253 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6254
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006255http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6256
6257 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6258 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6259 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6260 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006261 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6262 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006263
6264 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6265
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006266http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006267http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006268http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006269http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006270http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006271http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006272http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006273http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6274http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006275
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006276 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6277
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006278 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006279 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6280 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6281 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6282 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006283
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006284 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6285 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6286 the supported backend.
6287
6288 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6289 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6290 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6291 number of segments in the path.
6292
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006293 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6294 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6295 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6296 when improperly combined.
6297
6298 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6299 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6300 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6301 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6302 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6303
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006304 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006305
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006306 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6307
6308 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6309 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6310
6311 Example:
6312 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6313
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006314 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6315
6316 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6317 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6318
6319 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6320 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6321
6322 Example:
6323 - /#foo -> /
6324
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006325 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6326 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006327
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006328 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6329 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6330
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006331 Example:
6332 - /. -> /
6333 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6334 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6335 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006336
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006337 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6338 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6339
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006340 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006341 their preceding segment.
6342
6343 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6344 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6345
6346 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6347 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006348
6349 Example:
6350 - /foo/../ -> /
6351 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6352 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6353 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006354 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006355 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006356 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006357
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006358 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6359 removed as well:
6360
6361 Example:
6362 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6363 - /bar/../../ -> /
6364
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006365 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6366 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006367
6368 Example:
6369 - // -> /
6370 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6371
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006372 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6373 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6374
6375 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6376 ".", "_", and "~".
6377
6378 Example:
6379 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6380 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6381 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6382 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6383
6384 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6385 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6386
6387 Example:
6388 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6389 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6390
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006391 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006392 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006393
6394 Example:
6395 - /%6f -> /%6F
6396 - /%zz -> /%zz
6397
6398 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6399 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6400
6401 Example:
6402 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6403
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006404 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006405 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6406 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6407
6408 Example:
6409 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6410 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6411 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6412
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006413http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006415 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6416 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6417 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6418 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6419 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006420
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006421http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006422
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006423 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6424 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6425 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6426 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006427
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006428http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6429 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006430
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006431 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006432 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6433 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6434 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6435 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6436 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006437
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006438 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6439 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6440 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6441 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6442 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006443
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006444 Example:
6445 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6446
6447 # applied to:
6448 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6449
6450 # outputs:
6451 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6452
6453 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006454
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006455 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6456
6457 # applied to:
6458 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006459
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006460 # outputs:
6461 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006462
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006463http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6464 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6465
6466 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6467 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006468 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6469 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6470 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006471
6472 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6473 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6474 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6475
6476 Example:
6477 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6478 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6479
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006480 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6481 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6482 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6483 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6484
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006485http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6486 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6487
6488 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6489 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6490 query-string are replaced.
6491
6492 Example:
6493 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6494 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6495
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006496http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6497 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6498
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006499 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6500 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6501 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6502 against.
6503
6504 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6505 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6506 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006507
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006508 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6509 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6510 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6511 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6512 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6513 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6514 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6515 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6516 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006517 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6518 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006519
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006520 Example:
6521 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6522 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006523
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006524 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6525 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006526
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006527http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6528 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006529
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006530 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6531 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6532 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6533 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006534
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006535 Example:
6536 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006537
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006538 # applied to:
6539 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006540
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006541 # outputs:
6542 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006543
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006544http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6545 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6546 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006547 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006548 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6549
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006550 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006551 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6552 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006553 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006554 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006555 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006556 are followed to create the response :
6557
6558 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6559 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6560 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6561 ignored.
6562
6563 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6564 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006565 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006566 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6567 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006568
6569 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6570 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6571 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006572 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006573 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006574
6575 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6576 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6577 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006578 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006579 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006580 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006581
6582 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6583 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6584 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6585 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6586 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6587 as a raw content.
6588
6589 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6590 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6591 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6592 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6593 considered as a raw string.
6594
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006595 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006596 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6597 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6598 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6599
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006600 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6601 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006602 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006603
6604 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6605
6606 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006607 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006608 if { path /ping }
6609
6610 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6611 if { path /favicon.ico }
6612
6613 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6614 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6615 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006617http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6618http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006620 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6621 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6622 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006623
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006624http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6625 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006626
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006627 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6628 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6629 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6630 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006632http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006633
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006634 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6635 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6636 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6637 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6638 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006640 Arguments:
6641 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6642 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006643
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006644 Example:
6645 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6646 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006648 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6649 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006651http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006652
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006653 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6654 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6655 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006656
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006657 Arguments:
6658 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6659 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006660
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006661 Example:
6662 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6663 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006665 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6666 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6667 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006669http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006671 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6672 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6673 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6674 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6675 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006677 Example:
6678 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6679 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6680 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6681 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6682 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6683 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6684 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6685 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6686 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006687
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006688http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006689
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006690 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6691 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6692 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6693 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6694 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006695
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006696http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6697 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006698
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006699 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6700 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6701 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6702 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6703 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6704 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6705 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6706 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6707 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006708
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006709http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006710
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006711 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6712 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6713 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6714 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6715 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6716 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6717 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006719http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006721 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6722 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6723 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006724
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006725http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006726
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006727 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6728 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6729 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6730 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6731 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6732 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6733 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6734 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006736http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006737
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006738 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6739 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6740 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6741 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6742 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6743 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006744
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006745 Example :
6746 # prepend the host name before the path
6747 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006748
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006749http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6750
6751 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6752 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6753 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6754
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006755http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006756
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006757 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6758 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6759 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6760 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6761 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006762
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006763http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006764
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006765 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6766 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6767 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6768 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6769 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6770 values have higher priority.
6771 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6772 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6773 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6774 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6775 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006776
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006777http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006778
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006779 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6780 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6781 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6782 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6783 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6784 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6785 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006786
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006787 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006788
6789 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006790 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6791 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006792
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006793http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6794 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6795 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6796 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006797 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6798 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006799
6800 Arguments :
6801 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6802 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006803
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006804 See also "option forwardfor".
6805
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006806 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006807 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6808 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6809
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006810 # After the masking this will track connections
6811 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6812 http-request track-sc0 src
6813
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006814 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6815 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6816
6817http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6818
6819 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6820 expression.
6821
6822 Arguments:
6823 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6824 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006825
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006826 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006827 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6828 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6829
6830 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6831 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6832 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6833
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006834http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006835 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6836
6837 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6838 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6839 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6840 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6841 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6842
6843 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6844 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6845 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6846 results.
6847
6848 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006849 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6850 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006851
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006852http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6853
6854 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6855 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6856 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6857 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6858 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6859 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6860 information from the request.
6861
6862 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6863
6864http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6865
6866 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6867 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulete6794272022-11-22 15:41:48 +01006868 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
6869 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
6870 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
6871 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
6872 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006873 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6874
6875http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6876
6877 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6878 inline.
6879
6880 Arguments:
6881 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6882 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6883 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6884 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6885 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6886 (request and response)
6887 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6888 processing
6889 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6890 processing
6891 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6892 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6893 and '_'.
6894
6895 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6896 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006897
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006898 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006899 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006900
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006901http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6902 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006903
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006904 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6905 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6906 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6907 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6908 agent name must be used.
6909
6910 Arguments:
6911 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6912
6913 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6914 configuration.
6915
6916http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6917
6918 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6919 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6920 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6921 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6922 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6923 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6924 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6925 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6926 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6927 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6928 action.
6929 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6930 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6931 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6932 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6933 you fully understand how it works.
6934
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006935http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6936
6937 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6938 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6939 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6940 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6941 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006942 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006943 processing.
6944
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006945 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006946 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6947 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6948 rules evaluation.
6949
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006950http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6951http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6952 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6953 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6954 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6955 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006956
6957 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6958 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6959 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006960 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6961 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6962 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6963 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6964 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6965 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006966 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006967 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6968 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6969 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006970 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006971 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6972 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6973 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6974 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6975 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006976
6977http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6978http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6979http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6980
6981 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6982 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6983 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6984 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006985 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006986 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6987 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6988 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6989 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6990 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6991 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6992 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6993
6994 Arguments :
6995 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6996 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6997 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6998 select which table entry to update the counters.
6999
7000 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7001 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7002 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7003 that table until the session ends.
7004
7005 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7006 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7007 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7008 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7009 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7010 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7011 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7012 useful information.
7013
7014 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7015 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7016 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7017 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7018 checks that make use of it.
7019
7020http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7021
7022 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007023
7024 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007025 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007026
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007027http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7028
7029 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7030 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7031 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7032 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7033 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7034 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7035
7036 Arguments :
7037 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7038
7039 Example:
7040 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7041
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007042http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7043 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7044
Thayne McCombs25d2d8a2024-01-28 22:07:32 -07007045 This will delay the processing of the request or response until one of the
7046 following conditions occurs:
7047 - The full request body is received, in which case processing proceeds
7048 normally.
7049 - <bytes> bytes have been received, when the "at-least" argument is given and
7050 <bytes> is non-zero, in which case processing proceeds normally.
7051 - The request buffer is full, in which case processing proceeds normally. The
7052 size of this buffer is determined by the "tune.bufsize" option.
7053 - The request has been waiting for more than <time> milliseconds. In this
7054 case HAProxy will respond with a 408 "Request Timeout" error to the client
7055 and stop processing the request. Note that if any of the other conditions
7056 happens first, this timeout will not occur even if the full body has
7057 not yet been recieved.
7058
7059 This action may be used as a replacement for "option http-buffer-request".
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007060
7061 Arguments :
7062
7063 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7064 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7065
7066 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007067 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Thayne McCombs25d2d8a2024-01-28 22:07:32 -07007068 bytes. A value of 0 (the default) means no limit.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007069
7070 Example:
7071 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7072
7073 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7074
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007075http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007076
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007077 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7078 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7079 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007080
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007081
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007082http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007083 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7084
7085 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7086 no | yes | yes | yes
7087
7088 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7089 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7090 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7091 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7092 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7093 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007095 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7096 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007097
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007098 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007099
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007100 Example:
7101 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007103 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007105 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7106 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007107
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007108 Example:
7109 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007110
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007111 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007112
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007113 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7114 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007116 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7117 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007118
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007119http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007120
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007121 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7122 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7123 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7124 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7125 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7126 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7127 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7128 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007129
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007130http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007131
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007132 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7133 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7134 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7135 example, or to pass some internal information.
7136 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7137 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7138 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007139
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007140http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007141
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007142 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7143 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007144
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007145http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007146
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007147 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007148
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007149http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007150
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007151 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7152 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7153 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7154 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7155 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7156 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7157 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007158
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007159 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7160 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7161 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7162 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7163 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007164
7165 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7166 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7167 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7168 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007169
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007170http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007171
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007172 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7173 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7174 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7175 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7176 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7177 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007178
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007179http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007180
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007181 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7182 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7183 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7184 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7185 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007187http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007189 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7190 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7191 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7192 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7193 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7194 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007195
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007196http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7197http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7198 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7199 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7200 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7201 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007202
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007203 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7204 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7205 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007206 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007207 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7208 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7209 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007210 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007211 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007212
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007213http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007214
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007215 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7216 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7217 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7218 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7219 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7220 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007221
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007222http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7223 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007224
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007225 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7226 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007227
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007228 Example:
7229 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007230
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007231 # applied to:
7232 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007233
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007234 # outputs:
7235 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007236
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007237 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007238
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007239http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7240 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007241
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007242 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007243 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007244
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007245 Example:
7246 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007247
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007248 # applied to:
7249 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007250
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007251 # outputs:
7252 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007253
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007254http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7255 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7256 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007257 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007258 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7259
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007260 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007261 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7262 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007263 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007264 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007265 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007266 are followed to create the response :
7267
7268 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7269 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7270 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7271 ignored.
7272
7273 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7274 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007275 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007276 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7277 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007278
7279 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7280 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7281 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007282 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007283 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007284
7285 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7286 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7287 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007288 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007289 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007290 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007291
7292 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7293 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7294 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7295 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7296 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7297 as a raw content.
7298
7299 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7300 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7301 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7302 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7303 considered as a raw string.
7304
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007305 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7306 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7307 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7308 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7309
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007310 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7311 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007312 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007313
7314 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7315
7316 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007317 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007318 if { status eq 404 }
7319
7320 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7321 string "This is the end !" \
7322 if { status eq 500 }
7323
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007324http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7325http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007326
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007327 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7328 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7329 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007330
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007331http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7332 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007333
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007334 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7335 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7336 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7337 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007338
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007339http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7340 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007341
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007342 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7343 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7344 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7345 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7346 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007347
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007348 Arguments:
7349 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007350
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007351 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7352 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007353
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007354http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007355
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007356 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7357 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7358 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007359
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007360http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7361
7362 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7363 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7364 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7365 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7366 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7367
7368http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7369
7370 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7371 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7372 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7373 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7374 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7375 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7376 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7377 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7378 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7379
7380http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7381
7382 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7383 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7384 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7385 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7386 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7387 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7388 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7389
7390http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7391
7392 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7393 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7394 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7395 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7396 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7397 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7398 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7399 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7400
7401http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7402 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7403
7404 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7405 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7406 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7407 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007408
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007409 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007410 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7411 http-response set-status 431
7412 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7413 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007414
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007415http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007416
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007417 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7418 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7419 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7420 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7421 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7422 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7423 based on some information from the request.
7424
7425 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7426
7427http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7428
7429 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7430 inline.
7431
7432 Arguments:
7433 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7434 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7435 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7436 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7437 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7438 (request and response)
7439 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7440 processing
7441 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7442 processing
7443 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7444 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7445 and '_'.
7446
7447 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7448 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007449
7450 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007451 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007452
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007453http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007454
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007455 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7456 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7457 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7458 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7459 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7460 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7461 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7462 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7463 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7464 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7465 action.
7466 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7467 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7468 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7469 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7470 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007471
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007472http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7473
7474 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7475 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7476 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7477 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7478 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007479 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007480 processing.
7481
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007482 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007483 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007484 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007485 rules evaluation.
7486
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007487http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7488http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7489http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007490
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007491 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7492 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7493 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7494 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7495 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007496 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007497
7498http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7499
7500 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7501 about <var-name>.
7502
7503 Example:
7504 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7505
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007506http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7507 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7508
7509 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7510 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7511 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7512 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7513 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7514 buffer is full.
7515
7516 Arguments :
7517
7518 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7519 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7520
7521 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007522 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007523 bytes.
7524
7525 Example:
7526 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007527
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007528http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7529 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7530
7531 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7532 yes | no | yes | yes
7533
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007534 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007535 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7536 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7537 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007538
7539 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7540
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007541 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7542 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7543 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7544 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7545 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7546 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7547 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007548 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007549 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7550 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007551
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007552 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7553 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7554 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7555 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7556 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7557 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7558 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007559 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7560 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7561 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7562 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7563 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7564 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007565
7566 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7567 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7568 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7569 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7570 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7571 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7572 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7573 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007574 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007575 downsides of rare connection failures.
7576
7577 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7578 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7579 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7580 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7581 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7582 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007583 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007584 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7585 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7586 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7587 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7588 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7589
7590 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007591 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7592 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7593 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7594 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007595
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007596 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7597 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007598
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007599 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007600
7601 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7602 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7603 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7604
Willy Tarreauee9afa22022-11-25 09:17:18 +01007605 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
7606 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
7607 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
7608 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
7609 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
7610 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
7611 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
7612 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
7613 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
7614 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
7615 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
7616
7617 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
7618 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
7619 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
7620 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
7621 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
7622
7623 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
7624 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007625
7626
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007627http-send-name-header [<header>]
7628 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007629 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7630 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007631 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007632 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7633
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007634 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7635 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7636 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7637 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7638 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7639 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7640 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7641 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7642 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7643 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7644 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7645 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7646 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7647 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7648 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7649 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007650
7651 See also : "server"
7652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007653id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007654 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7656 no | yes | yes | yes
7657 Arguments : none
7658
7659 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7660 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7661 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007662
7663
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007664ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7665 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7666 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007667 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007668
7669 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7670 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7671 and running).
7672
7673 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7674 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7675 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007676 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007677 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7678
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007679 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7680 "unless" condition is met.
7681
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007682 Example:
7683 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7684 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7685 ignore-persist if url_static
7686
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007687 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7688
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007689load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7690 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7691 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7692 yes | no | yes | yes
7693
7694 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7695 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7696 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007697 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007698 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007699 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7700 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7701 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7702
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007703 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007704 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007705 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007706
7707 Arguments:
7708 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7709 named "server-state-file".
7710
7711 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7712 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7713 name is used as a file name.
7714
7715 none don't load any stat for this backend
7716
7717 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007718 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7719 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7720 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007721 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007722 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007723
7724 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7725 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7726
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007727 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007728
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007729 global
7730 stats socket /tmp/socket
7731 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007732
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007733 defaults
7734 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007735
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007736 backend bk
7737 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7738 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007739
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007740
7741 Then one can run :
7742
7743 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7744
7745 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7746
7747 1
7748 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7749 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7750 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7751
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007752 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007753
7754 global
7755 stats socket /tmp/socket
7756 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7757
7758 defaults
7759 load-server-state-from-file local
7760
7761 backend bk
7762 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7763 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7764
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007765
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007766 Then one can run :
7767
7768 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7769
7770 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7771
7772 1
7773 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7774 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7775 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7776
7777 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7778 "show servers state"
7779
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007780
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007781log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007782log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007783 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007784no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007785 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7787 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007788
7789 Prefix :
7790 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7791 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7792 prefix does not allow arguments.
7793
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007794 Arguments :
7795 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7796 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7797 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7798 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7799 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7800 parameter.
7801
7802 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7803 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7804
7805 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7806 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7807 standard syslog port).
7808
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007809 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7810 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7811 standard syslog port).
7812
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007813 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7814 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7815 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007816 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007817
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007818 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7819 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7820 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7821 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7822 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7823 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7824 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7825 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7826 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7827 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7828 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7829 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007830 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007831 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7832 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7833 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007834 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7835 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007836
7837 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7838 and "fd@2", see above.
7839
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007840 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7841 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7842 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7843 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7844 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7845 having the logs instantly available.
7846
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007847 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7848 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7849 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7850
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007851 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7852 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007853
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007854 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7855 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7856 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7857 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7858 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7859 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7860 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7861 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7862 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7863 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007864 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007865
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007866 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7867 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7868 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7869 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7870 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7871
7872 <sample_size>
7873 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7874 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7875 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7876 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7877 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7878
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007879 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7880 one of the following :
7881
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007882 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7883 field is stripped. This is the default.
7884 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7885 rfc3164.
7886
7887 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007888 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7889
7890 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7891 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7892
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007893 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7894 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7895 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7896 designed to be used with a local log server.
7897
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007898 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7899 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7900 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7901 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7902 systemd logger consumes.
7903
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007904 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7905 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7906 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7907 used with a local log server.
7908
7909 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7910 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7911 designed to be used with a local log server.
7912
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007913 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7914 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7915 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7916 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7917
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007918 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7919
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007920 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7921 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7922 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7923
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007924 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7925 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7926 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7927 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007928
7929 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7930 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7931 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007932 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7933 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7934 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7935 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7936 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007937
7938 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7939
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007940 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7941 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7942 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007943
7944 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7945 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7946 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7947 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7948
7949 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7950 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007951
7952 Example :
7953 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007954 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7955 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7956 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007957 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007958 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7959 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007960 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007961
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007962
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007963log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007964 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7965 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7966 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007967
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007968 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7969 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7970 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7971 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7972 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007973
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007974 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7975 "option httplog" directives.
7976
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007977log-format-sd <string>
7978 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7979 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7980 yes | yes | yes | no
7981
7982 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7983 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7984 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7985 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7986 which covers the log format string in depth.
7987
7988 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7989 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7990
7991 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7992 log format to "rfc5424".
7993
7994 Example :
7995 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7996
7997
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007998log-tag <string>
7999 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
8000 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8001 yes | yes | yes | yes
8002
8003 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
8004 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008005 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008006 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8007 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8008 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8009 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8010 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8011 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008012
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008013max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8014 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8015 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8016 yes | no | yes | yes
8017
8018 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8019 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8020 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8021 servers.
8022
8023 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008024 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008025 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8026 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8027 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008028 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008029 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8030 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8031 picking a different server.
8032
8033 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8034 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8035 even if they have to be queued.
8036
8037 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8038 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8039
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008040max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8041 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8042 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8043 defined at build time).
Aurelien DARRAGON85f953c2023-11-20 17:53:36 +01008044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8045 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008046
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008047maxconn <conns>
8048 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8050 yes | yes | yes | no
8051 Arguments :
8052 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8053 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8054 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8055 closes.
8056
8057 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008058 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008059 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8060 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008061 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8062 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8063 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8064 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008065
8066 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8067 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8068 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8069
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008070 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8071 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008072
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008073 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8074
8075
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008076mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008077 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8079 yes | yes | yes | yes
8080 Arguments :
8081 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8082 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8083 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8084 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8085
8086 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8087 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8088 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8089 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8090 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8091
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008092 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8093 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8094 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008095
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008096 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008097 defaults http_instances
8098 mode http
8099
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008100
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008101monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008102 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8104 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008105 Arguments :
8106 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8107 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008108 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008109 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8110 backend and its backup.
8111
8112 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8113 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8114 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8115 servers in a list of backends.
8116
8117 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8118 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8119 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008120 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008121 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8122 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008123 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008124 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8125 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008126
8127 Example:
8128 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008129 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008130 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8131 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8132 monitor-uri /site_alive
8133 monitor fail if site_dead
8134
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008135 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008136
8137
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008138monitor-uri <uri>
8139 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8141 yes | yes | yes | no
8142 Arguments :
8143 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8144 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8145
8146 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8147 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8148 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8149 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8150 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8151 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8152 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8153 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8154
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008155 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008156 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8157 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau28848542022-11-25 10:24:44 +01008158 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
8159 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
8160 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008161 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8162 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8163 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008164
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008165 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8166 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8167 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8168 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8169
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008170 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008171 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008172 frontend www
8173 mode http
8174 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8175
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008176 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008177
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008178
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008179option abortonclose
8180no option abortonclose
8181 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8183 yes | no | yes | yes
8184 Arguments : none
8185
8186 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8187 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8188 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8189 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008190 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008191 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8192 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8193 encountered while delivering the response.
8194
8195 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8196 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8197 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8198 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8199 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8200 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008201 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008202 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008203 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008204 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8205 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8206 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8207
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008208 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8209 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008210 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8211 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8212 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8213 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8214 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8215 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008216 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008217
8218 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8219 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8220
8221 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8222
8223
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008224option accept-invalid-http-request
8225no option accept-invalid-http-request
8226 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8228 yes | yes | yes | no
8229 Arguments : none
8230
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008231 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008232 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008233 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008234 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8235 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8236 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8237 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8238 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008239 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8240 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8241 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8242 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008243 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008244 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008245 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8246 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
Willy Tarreau3706e172023-08-08 19:35:25 +02008247 and the minor version. Finally, this option also allows incoming URLs to
8248 contain fragment references ('#' after the path).
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008249
8250 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8251 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8252 been confirmed.
8253
8254 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8255 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008256 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8257 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008258 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8259
8260 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8261 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8262
8263 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8264 stats socket.
8265
8266
8267option accept-invalid-http-response
8268no option accept-invalid-http-response
8269 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8271 yes | no | yes | yes
8272 Arguments : none
8273
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008274 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008275 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008276 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008277 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8278 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8279 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8280 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8281 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008282 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8283 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8284 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008285
8286 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8287 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8288 been confirmed.
8289
8290 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8291 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8292 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8293 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8294
8295 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8296 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8297
8298 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8299 stats socket.
8300
8301
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008302option allbackups
8303no option allbackups
8304 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8306 yes | no | yes | yes
8307 Arguments : none
8308
8309 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8310 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8311 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8312 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8313 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8314 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8315 order between the backup servers anymore.
8316
8317 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8318 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8319
8320 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8321 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8322
8323
8324option checkcache
8325no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008326 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8328 yes | no | yes | yes
8329 Arguments : none
8330
8331 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8332 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008333 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008334 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8335 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008336 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008337
8338 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008339 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008340 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008341 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8342 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008343 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008344 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008345 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8346 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008347 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008348 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8349 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008350 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008351 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8352 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8353 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8354 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8355 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8356 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8357 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8358 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8359 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8360
8361 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008362 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8363 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8364 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8365 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008366
8367 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8368 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008369 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008370 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008371
8372 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8373 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8374
8375
8376option clitcpka
8377no option clitcpka
8378 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8380 yes | yes | yes | no
8381 Arguments : none
8382
8383 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8384 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008385 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008386 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8387
8388 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8389 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8390 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8391 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8392
8393 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8394 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8395 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8396 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8397 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8398
8399 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8400
8401 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8402 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8403 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8404
8405 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8406 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8407
8408 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8409
8410
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008411option contstats
8412 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8414 yes | yes | yes | no
8415 Arguments : none
8416
8417 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8418 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8419 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008420 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008421 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8422 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8423 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8424 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8425 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008426
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008427option disable-h2-upgrade
8428no option disable-h2-upgrade
8429 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8430 connection.
8431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8432 yes | yes | yes | no
8433 Arguments : none
8434
8435 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8436 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8437 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8438 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008439 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8440 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8441 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8442 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8443 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8444 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008445
8446 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8447 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008448
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008449option dontlog-normal
8450no option dontlog-normal
8451 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8453 yes | yes | yes | no
8454 Arguments : none
8455
8456 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8457 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8458 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8459 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8460 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8461 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8462 logged.
8463
8464 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8465 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8466 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008468 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008469 logging.
8470
8471
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008472option dontlognull
8473no option dontlognull
8474 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8476 yes | yes | yes | no
8477 Arguments : none
8478
8479 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8480 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8481 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8482 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8483 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8484 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008485 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8486 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8487 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008488
8489 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008490 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008491 would not be logged.
8492
8493 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8494 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8495
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008496 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008497 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008498
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008499
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008500option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008501 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8503 yes | yes | yes | yes
8504 Arguments :
8505 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8506 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008507 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008508 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008509
8510 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8511 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8512 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8513 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8514 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8515 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8516 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008517 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8518 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8519 possible that the client has already brought one.
8520
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008521 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008522 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008523 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008524 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008525 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008526 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008527
8528 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8529 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8530 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8531 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8532 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8533 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008534 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008535
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008536 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8537 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008538 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008539 are under the control of the end-user.
8540
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008541 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008542 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8543 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008544 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8545 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8546 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008547
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008548 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008549 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8550 frontend www
8551 mode http
8552 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8553
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008554 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8555 backend www
8556 mode http
8557 option forwardfor header X-Client
8558
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008559 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008560 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008561
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008562
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008563option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8564no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8565 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8567 yes | yes | yes | no
8568 Arguments : none
8569
8570 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8571 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8572 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8573 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8574 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8575 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8576 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8577
8578 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8579 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8580 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8581 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8582 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8583 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8584 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8585 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8586 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8587 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8588
8589 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8590
8591 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8592 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8593
8594 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8595 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8596
8597
8598option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8599no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8600 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8602 yes | no | yes | yes
8603 Arguments : none
8604
8605 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8606 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8607 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8608 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8609 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8610 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8611 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8612
8613 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8614 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8615 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8616 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8617 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8618 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8619 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8620 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8621 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8622 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8623
8624 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8625
8626 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8627 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8628
8629 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8630 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8631
8632
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008633option http-buffer-request
8634no option http-buffer-request
8635 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8637 yes | yes | yes | yes
8638 Arguments : none
8639
8640 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8641 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8642 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8643 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8644 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8645 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008646 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8647 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8648 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8649 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008650
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008651 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8652 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008653
8654
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008655option http-ignore-probes
8656no option http-ignore-probes
8657 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8659 yes | yes | yes | no
8660 Arguments : none
8661
8662 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8663 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8664 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8665 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8666 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8667 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8668 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8669 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8670 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008671 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8672 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008673 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8674
8675 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8676 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8677 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8678 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8679 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8680 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8681 are often the only way to detect them.
8682
8683 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8684 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8685
8686 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8687
8688
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008689option http-keep-alive
8690no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008691 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
8692 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8694 yes | yes | yes | yes
8695 Arguments : none
8696
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008697 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008698 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8699 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8700 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8701 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
8702 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008703
8704 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8705 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008706 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8707 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8708 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8709 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8710 situations where this option may be useful :
8711
8712 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008713 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008714
8715 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8716 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8717
8718 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008719
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008720 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8721 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8722 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8723 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8724 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8725 not set.
8726
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008727 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008728 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008729
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008730 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008731 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008732
8733
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008734option http-no-delay
8735no option http-no-delay
8736 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8738 yes | yes | yes | yes
8739 Arguments : none
8740
8741 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8742 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8743 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8744 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8745 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8746 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8747 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008748 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008749 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8750 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8751 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8752 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8753 affected.
8754
8755 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8756 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8757 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8758 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8759 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8760 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8761 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8762 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8763 latency environments.
8764
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008765 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8766
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008767
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008768option http-pretend-keepalive
8769no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008770 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
8771 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008773 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008774 Arguments : none
8775
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008776 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008777 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
8778 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
8779 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
8780 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
8781 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
8782 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008783
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008784 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008785 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008786 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008787 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008788 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008789 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8790
8791 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8792 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8793 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8794 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008795 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8796 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008797 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8798
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008799 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8800 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8801 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008802 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008803
8804 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8805 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8806
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008807 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008808 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008809
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008810option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8811 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8812 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8814 yes | yes | yes | yes
8815 Arguments :
8816 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8817 with no FastCGI application configured.
8818
8819 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8820 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8821 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8822
8823 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8824 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8825
8826 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8827 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8828 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8829 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8830 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8831 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8832 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8833 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8834
8835 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8836 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008837
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008838option http-server-close
8839no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008840 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8842 yes | yes | yes | yes
8843 Arguments : none
8844
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008845 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008846 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8847 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8848 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8849 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
8850 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
8851 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
8852 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
8853 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
8854 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
8855 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
8856 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
8857 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
8858 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008859
8860 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8861 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8862 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8863 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008864 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8865 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008866
8867 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8868 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008869 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8870 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8871 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008872
8873 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8874 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8875
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008876 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
8877 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008878
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008879option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008880no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008881 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8883 yes | yes | yes | no
8884 Arguments : none
8885
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008886 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008887 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8888 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8889 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8890 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8891 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008892 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008893
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008894 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008895 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008896 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8897 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8898 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008899
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008900 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8901 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8902 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8903 front of an existing proxy.
8904
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008905 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8906
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008907 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008908
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008909option httpchk
8910option httpchk <uri>
8911option httpchk <method> <uri>
8912option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008913 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8915 yes | no | yes | yes
8916 Arguments :
8917 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8918 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8919 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8920 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8921 ones.
8922
8923 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8924 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8925 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8926
8927 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8928 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8929 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008930 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008931
8932 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8933 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8934 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8935 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8936 the lack of any response.
8937
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008938 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8939 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8940 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8941 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8942
8943 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8944 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8945 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008946
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008947 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8948 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008949 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008950 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008951 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008952
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008953 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8954 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8955 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8956 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8957
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008958 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008959 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8960 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8961 backend https_relay
8962 mode tcp
8963 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8964 http-check send hdr Host www
8965 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008966
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008967 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8968 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8969 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008970
8971
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008972option httpclose
8973no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008974 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8976 yes | yes | yes | yes
8977 Arguments : none
8978
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008979 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008980 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8981 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8982 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8983 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008984
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008985 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
8986 connection, depending where the option is set. Only the frontend is
8987 considered for client connections while the frontend and the backend are
8988 considered for server ones. In this case the option is enabled if at least
8989 one of the frontend or backend holding the connection has it enabled. If the
8990 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
8991 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
8992 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008993
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008994 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008995 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
8996 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008997
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008998 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008999 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009000
9001 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9002 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9003
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009004 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009005
9006
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009007option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009008 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
9009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009010 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009011 Arguments :
9012 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
9013 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
9014 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009015 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009016 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009017
9018 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9019 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9020 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9021 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9022 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9023 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
9024 ports.
9025
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01009026 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
9027 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009028
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009029 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9030
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009031 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009032
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009033
9034option http_proxy
9035no option http_proxy
9036 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
9037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9038 yes | yes | yes | yes
9039 Arguments : none
9040
9041 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
9042 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
9043 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
9044 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
9045 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
9046
9047 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
9048 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009049 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
9050 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009051
9052 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9053 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9054
9055 Example :
9056 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
9057 backend direct_forward
9058 option httpclose
9059 option http_proxy
9060
9061 See also : "option httpclose"
9062
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009063
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009064option independent-streams
9065no option independent-streams
9066 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9068 yes | yes | yes | yes
9069 Arguments : none
9070
9071 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9072 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9073 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9074 receive data or not.
9075
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009076 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009077 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9078 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9079 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9080 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9081 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9082 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9083 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9084 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9085 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9086 socket buffers.
9087
9088 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9089 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9090 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9091 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9092 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9093
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009094 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009095
9096
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009097option ldap-check
9098 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9100 yes | no | yes | yes
9101 Arguments : none
9102
9103 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9104 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9105 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9106 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9107
9108 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9109 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9110
9111 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9112 configure it.
9113
9114 Example :
9115 option ldap-check
9116
9117 See also : "option httpchk"
9118
9119
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009120option external-check
9121 Use external processes for server health checks
9122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9123 yes | no | yes | yes
9124
9125 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9126 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9127 command".
9128
9129 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9130
9131 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9132
9133
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009134option idle-close-on-response
9135no option idle-close-on-response
9136 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9138 yes | yes | yes | no
9139 Arguments : none
9140
9141 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9142 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9143 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9144 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9145 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9146 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9147 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9148 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9149 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9150
9151 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9152 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9153
9154 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9155 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9156 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9157 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9158
9159 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9160 "hard-stop-after"
9161
9162
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009163option log-health-checks
9164no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009165 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9167 yes | no | yes | yes
9168 Arguments : none
9169
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009170 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9171 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9172 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009173
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009174 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9175 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9176 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9177 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9178 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9179
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009180 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009181 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009182
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009183 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9184 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9185 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009186
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009187
9188option log-separate-errors
9189no option log-separate-errors
9190 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9192 yes | yes | yes | no
9193 Arguments : none
9194
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009195 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009196 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9197 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9198 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9199 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9200 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9201 provides very important information.
9202
9203 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9204 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9205 error logs.
9206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009207 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009208 logging.
9209
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009210
9211option logasap
9212no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009213 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9215 yes | yes | yes | no
9216 Arguments : none
9217
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009218 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9219 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9220 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9221 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9222
9223 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9224 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9225 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9226 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9227 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009228 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009229 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9230 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9231 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9232 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009233 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009234
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009235 Examples :
9236 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9237 mode http
9238 option httplog
9239 option logasap
9240 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9241
9242 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9243 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9244 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9245 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9246
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009247 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009248 logging.
9249
9250
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009251option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009252 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9254 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009255 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009256 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9257 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009258 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9259 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009260
9261 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9262 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009263 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009264 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009265 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9266 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9267 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009268
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009269 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9270 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9271 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009272
9273 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009274 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009275 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9276 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9277 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9278 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9279 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9280 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9281 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9282
9283 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9284 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009285
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009286 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009287
9288 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9289 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9290 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9291 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009292 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009293 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009294
9295 See also: "option httpchk"
9296
9297
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009298option nolinger
9299no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009300 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009301 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9302 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009303 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009304
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009305 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009306 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9307 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9308 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9309 connections.
9310
9311 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9312 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009313 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9314 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9315 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9316 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9317 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9318 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9319 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9320 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9321 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9322 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9323 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9324 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9325 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009326
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009327 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9328 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9329 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9330 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9331 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009332
9333 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9334 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009335 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009336 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009337 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009338
9339 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9340 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9341
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009342 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9343 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009344
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009345option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9346 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9348 yes | yes | yes | yes
9349 Arguments :
9350 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9351 matching <network>
9352 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9353 header name.
9354
9355 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9356 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9357 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9358 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9359 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9360 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9361 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9362 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9363 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9364 possible that the client has already brought one.
9365
9366 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9367 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9368 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9369 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9370 header and requires different one.
9371
9372 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9373 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9374 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009375 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9376 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9377 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9378 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9379 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009380
9381 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9382 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9383 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9384 both are defined.
9385
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009386 Examples :
9387 # Original Destination address
9388 frontend www
9389 mode http
9390 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9391
9392 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9393 backend www
9394 mode http
9395 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9396
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009397 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009398
9399
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009400option persist
9401no option persist
9402 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9403 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9404 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009405 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009406
9407 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9408 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9409 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9410 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9411 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9412 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9413 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9414 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9415 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9416 redirected to another valid server.
9417
9418 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9419 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9420
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009421 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009422
9423
Christopher Faulet36136e52022-10-03 15:00:59 +02009424option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009425 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9427 yes | no | yes | yes
9428 Arguments :
9429 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9430 PostgreSQL server.
9431
9432 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9433 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9434 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9435 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9436
9437 See also: "option httpchk"
9438
9439
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009440option prefer-last-server
9441no option prefer-last-server
9442 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9443 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9444 yes | no | yes | yes
9445 Arguments : none
9446
9447 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009448 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009449 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9450 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009451 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009452 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009453 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009454 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9455 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009456 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009457 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009458 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9459 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9460 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009461 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9462 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9463 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009464
9465 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9466 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9467
9468 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9469
9470
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009471option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009472option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009473no option redispatch
9474 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9475 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9476 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009477 Arguments :
9478 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9479 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9480 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009481 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009482 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009483 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009484 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9485 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9486 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9487
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009488
9489 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9490 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9491 be able to access the service anymore.
9492
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009493 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9494 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009495
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009496 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9497 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9498 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9499 following order:
9500
9501 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9502
9503 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9504 list, or
9505
9506 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9507
9508 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9509 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9510
9511 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9512 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9513 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9514 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9515
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009516 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009517 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9518 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009519
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009520 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9521 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9522
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009523 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009524
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009525
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009526option redis-check
9527 Use redis health checks for server testing
9528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9529 yes | no | yes | yes
9530 Arguments : none
9531
9532 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9533 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9534 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9535 find the "+PONG" response message.
9536
9537 Example :
9538 option redis-check
9539
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009540 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009541
9542
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009543option smtpchk
9544option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9545 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9547 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009548 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009549 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009550 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009551 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9552
9553 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9554 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9555 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9556
9557 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9558 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9559 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9560 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9561 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9562 dead server.
9563
9564 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9565 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009566 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009567 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9568
9569 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9570 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9571 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9572 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009573 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009574
9575 Example :
9576 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9577
9578 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9579
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009581option socket-stats
9582no option socket-stats
9583
9584 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9586 yes | yes | yes | no
9587
9588 Arguments : none
9589
9590
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009591option splice-auto
9592no option splice-auto
9593 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9595 yes | yes | yes | yes
9596 Arguments : none
9597
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009598 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009599 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009600 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009601 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009602 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009603 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9604 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9605 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9606 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9607
9608 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9609 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9610 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9611 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9612 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9613 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9614 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9615 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9616 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9617 keyword.
9618
9619 Example :
9620 option splice-auto
9621
9622 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9623 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9624
9625 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9626 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9627
9628
9629option splice-request
9630no option splice-request
9631 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9633 yes | yes | yes | yes
9634 Arguments : none
9635
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009636 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009637 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009638 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9639 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9640 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9641 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9642
9643 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9644
9645 Example :
9646 option splice-request
9647
9648 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9649 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9650
9651 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9652 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9653
9654
9655option splice-response
9656no option splice-response
9657 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9659 yes | yes | yes | yes
9660 Arguments : none
9661
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009662 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009663 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009664 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9665 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9666 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9667 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9668
9669 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9670
9671 Example :
9672 option splice-response
9673
9674 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9675 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9676
9677 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9678 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9679
9680
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009681option spop-check
9682 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGON54832622023-01-12 15:06:11 +01009684 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009685 Arguments : none
9686
9687 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9688 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9689 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9690 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9691
9692 Example :
9693 option spop-check
9694
9695 See also : "option httpchk"
9696
9697
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009698option srvtcpka
9699no option srvtcpka
9700 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9702 yes | no | yes | yes
9703 Arguments : none
9704
9705 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9706 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009707 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009708 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9709
9710 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9711 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9712 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9713 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9714
9715 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9716 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9717 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9718 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9719 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9720
9721 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9722
9723 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9724 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9725 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9726
9727 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9728 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9729
9730 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9731
9732
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009733option ssl-hello-chk
9734 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9736 yes | no | yes | yes
9737 Arguments : none
9738
9739 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9740 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9741 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9742 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9743 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9744 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9745 hello message.
9746
9747 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9748 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9749 messages, which is appreciable.
9750
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009751 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009752 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9753 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009754
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009755 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9756
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009757
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009758option tcp-check
9759 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9760 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9761 yes | no | yes | yes
9762
9763 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9764 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9765
9766 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9767 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9768 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9769
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009770 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009771 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9772 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9773 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9774 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9775 only.
9776
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009777 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009778 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009779 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9780 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9781 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9782
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009783 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009784 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9785 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009786 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009787 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9788 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9789 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9790 the respective protocols.
9791 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009792 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009793
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009794 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009795
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009796 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9797 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9798 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9799 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009800
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009801 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9802 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9803 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009804
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009805
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009806 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009807 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009808 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009809 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009810
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009811 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009812 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009813 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009814
9815 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9816 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009817 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009818 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009819 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009820 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009821 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009822 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009823 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9824 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009825 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009826 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9827 tcp-check expect string +OK
9828
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009829 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009830 (send many headers before analyzing)
9831 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009832 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009833 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9834 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9835 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9836 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009837 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009838
9839
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009840 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009841
9842
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009843option tcp-smart-accept
9844no option tcp-smart-accept
9845 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9847 yes | yes | yes | no
9848 Arguments : none
9849
9850 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9851 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9852 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9853 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9854 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9855 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9856
9857 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9858 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9859 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9860 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9861
9862 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9863 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9864 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009865 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009866
9867 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9868 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9869 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9870
9871 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9872 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9873 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9874
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009875 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9876
9877
9878option tcp-smart-connect
9879no option tcp-smart-connect
9880 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9882 yes | no | yes | yes
9883 Arguments : none
9884
9885 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9886 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9887 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9888 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9889 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9890
9891 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9892 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9893 complex.
9894
9895 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9896 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9897 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9898
9899 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9900 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9901
9902 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9903
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009904
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009905option tcpka
9906 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9908 yes | yes | yes | yes
9909 Arguments : none
9910
9911 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9912 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009913 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009914 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9915
9916 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9917 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9918 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9919 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9920
9921 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9922 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9923 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9924 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9925 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9926
9927 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9928
9929 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9930 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9931 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9932 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9933 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9934 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9935 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9936 backends.
9937
9938 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9939
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009940
9941option tcplog
9942 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009944 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009945 Arguments : none
9946
9947 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9948 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9949 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9950 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9951 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9952 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9953 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9954 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9955
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009956 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009958 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009959
9960
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009961option transparent
9962no option transparent
9963 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009965 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009966 Arguments : none
9967
9968 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9969 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9970 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9971 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9972 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9973 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9974 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9975 appropriate server.
9976
9977 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9978 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9979
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009980 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009981 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009982
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009983
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009984external-check command <command>
9985 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9987 yes | no | yes | yes
9988
9989 Arguments :
9990 <command> is the external command to run
9991
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009992 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9993
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009994 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009995
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009996 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9997 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9998 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9999 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
10000 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
10001 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010002
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010003 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
10004
10005 Environment variables :
10006 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
10007 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
10008
10009 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
10010
10011 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
10012
10013 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
10014 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
10015 for a UNIX socket).
10016
10017 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
10018
10019 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
10020
10021 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
10022
10023 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
10024
10025 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
10026
10027 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
10028 socket).
10029
10030 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10031 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10032
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010033 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10034
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010035 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10036 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10037 failed.
10038
10039 Example :
10040 external-check command /bin/true
10041
10042 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10043
10044
10045external-check path <path>
10046 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10048 yes | no | yes | yes
10049
10050 Arguments :
10051 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10052
10053 The default path is "".
10054
10055 Example :
10056 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10057
10058 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10059 "external-check command"
10060
10061
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010062persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010063persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010064 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10066 yes | no | yes | yes
10067 Arguments :
10068 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010069 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10070 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010071
10072 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10073 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010074 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010075 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10076 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10077 forwarded to this server.
10078
10079 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10080 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10081 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010082 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010083 a single "listen" section.
10084
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010085 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10086 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10087 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10088
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010089 Example :
10090 listen tse-farm
10091 bind :3389
10092 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10093 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10094 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10095 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10096 persist rdp-cookie
10097 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010098 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010099 balance rdp-cookie
10100 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10101 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10102
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010103 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010104
10105
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010106rate-limit sessions <rate>
10107 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10109 yes | yes | yes | no
10110 Arguments :
10111 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10112 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10113
10114 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10115 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10116 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010117 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010118 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10119 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10120
10121 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10122 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10123 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10124 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10125
10126 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10127 listen smtp
10128 mode tcp
10129 bind :25
10130 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010131 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010132
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010133 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10134 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10135 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010136
10137 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10138
10139
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010140redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10141redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10142redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010143 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10145 no | yes | yes | yes
10146
10147 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010148 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010149
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010150 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010151 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010152 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10153 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10154 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010155
10156 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10157 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10158 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10159 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10160 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010161 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10162 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10163 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10164 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010165
10166 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10167 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10168 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10169 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10170 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10171 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010172 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010173 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010174 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10175 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10176 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010177
10178 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010179 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10180 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10181 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010182 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010183 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10184 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10185 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10186 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010187
10188 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010189 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010190
10191 - "drop-query"
10192 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10193 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10194 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10195 with a location-type redirect.
10196
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010197 - "append-slash"
10198 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10199 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10200 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10201 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10202
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010203 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10204 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10205 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10206 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10207 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10208 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10209 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10210
10211 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10212 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10213 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10214 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10215 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10216 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10217 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010218
10219 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10220 acl clear dst_port 80
10221 acl secure dst_port 8080
10222 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010223 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010224 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010225 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10226
10227 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010228 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10229 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10230 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010231 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010232
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010233 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10234 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10235 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10236
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010237 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010238 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010239
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010240 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010241 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10242 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10243 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010245 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010246
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010247
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010248retries <value>
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010249 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010250 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10251 yes | no | yes | yes
10252 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010253 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
10254 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010255
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010256 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
10257 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
10258 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
10259 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
10260 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010261
10262 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010263 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010264 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010265
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010266 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
10267 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
10268 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010269
10270 See also : "option redispatch"
10271
10272
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010273retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010274 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10275 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10276 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10278 yes | no | yes | yes
10279 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010280 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10281 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10282 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10283 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10284 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010285
10286 none never retry
10287
10288 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10289 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10290
10291 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10292 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10293 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10294 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10295 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10296 processing the request.
10297
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010298 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10299 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10300 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10301 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10302 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10303 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10304 overflow attack for example).
10305
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010306 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10307 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10308 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10309 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10310 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10311 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10312 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10313 amplify denial of service attacks.
10314
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010315 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10316 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10317 considered to be safe to retry.
10318
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010319 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10320 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10321 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10322 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10323 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010324
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010325 all-retryable-errors
10326 retry request for any error that are considered
10327 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10328 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10329 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10330
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010331 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10332 not cumulative.
10333
10334 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10335 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10336 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10337 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10338
10339 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10340 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10341 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10342 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10343 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10344 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10345 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10346 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10347 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10348 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10349 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10350 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10351
10352 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10353 should not use this directive.
10354
10355 The default is "conn-failure".
10356
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010357 Example:
10358 retry-on 503 504
10359
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010360 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10361
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010362server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010363 Declare a server in a backend
10364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10365 no | no | yes | yes
10366 Arguments :
10367 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010368 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010369 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010370
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010371 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10372 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10373 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10374 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010375 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10376 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010377 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010378 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10379 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010380 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10381 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10382 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10383 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10384 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10385 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10386 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010387 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010388 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10389 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10390 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10391 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10392 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10393 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010394 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10395 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010396 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10397 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010398
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010399 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010400 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10401 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10402 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10403 adding this value to the client's port.
10404
10405 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10406 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010407 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010408
10409 Examples :
10410 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10411 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010412 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010413 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10414 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10415 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010416
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010417 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10418 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10419 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10420 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10421 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10422
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010423 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10424 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010425
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010426server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010427 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010428 this backend.
10429 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10430 no | no | yes | yes
10431
10432 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10433 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10434 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10435 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10436 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010437
10438 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10439 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10440
10441 global
10442 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10443
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010444 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010445 load-server-state-from-file
10446
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010447 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010448 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010449
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010450server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10451 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10452 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10454 no | no | yes | yes
10455
10456 Arguments:
10457 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10458
10459 <num | range>
10460 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10461 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10462 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10463 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10464
10465 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10466
10467 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10468
10469 <params*>
10470 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10471 keyword.
10472
10473 Examples:
10474 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10475 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10476 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10477
10478 # or
10479 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10480
10481 # would be equivalent to:
10482 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10483 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10484 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10485
10486
10487
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010488source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010489source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010490source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010491 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10493 yes | no | yes | yes
10494 Arguments :
10495 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10496 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010497
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010498 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010499 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10500 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10501 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10502 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10503 supported prefixes are :
10504 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10505 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10506 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010507 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010508 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10509 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010510
10511 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10512 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010513 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10514 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10515 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010516
10517 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10518 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10519 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10520 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10521 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10522 <addr>.
10523
10524 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10525 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10526 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10527 port.
10528
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010529 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10530 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10531 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10532 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010533 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010534 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10535 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10536 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10537 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10538 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10539 HTTP header.
10540
10541 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10542 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010543 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010544 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10545 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10546 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10547 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10548 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10549 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10550 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10551
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010552 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10553 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10554 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10555 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10556 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10557 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10558
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010559 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10560 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10561 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10562 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10563
10564 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10565 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10566 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10567 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10568 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10569 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10570
10571 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10572 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10573 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10574 there are two methods :
10575
10576 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10577 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10578 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10579 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10580 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10581 of the client ranges may be used.
10582
10583 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10584 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10585 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10586 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10587 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10588 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10589 same session.
10590
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010591 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10592 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10593 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010594 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010595
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010596 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10597
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010598 Examples :
10599 backend private
10600 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10601 source 192.168.1.200
10602
10603 backend transparent_ssl1
10604 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10605 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10606
10607 backend transparent_ssl2
10608 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10609 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10610 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10611
10612 backend transparent_ssl3
10613 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10614 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10615 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10616
10617 backend transparent_smtp
10618 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10619 # with Tproxy version 4.
10620 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10621
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010622 backend transparent_http
10623 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10624 # proxy.
10625 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010627 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010628 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10629
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010630
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010631srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10632 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10633 the connection on the server side.
10634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10635 yes | no | yes | yes
10636 Arguments :
10637 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10638
10639 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10640 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010641 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10642 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010643
10644 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10645
10646
10647srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10648 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10649 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10650 server side.
10651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10652 yes | no | yes | yes
10653 Arguments :
10654 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10655 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10656 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10657 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10658
10659 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10660 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010661 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10662 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010663
10664 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10665
10666
10667srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10668 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10670 yes | no | yes | yes
10671 Arguments :
10672 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10673 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10674 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10675 document.
10676
10677 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10678 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010679 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10680 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010681
10682 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10683
10684
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010685stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10686 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010688 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010689
10690 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10691 matched.
10692
10693 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10694 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10695
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010696 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10697 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010698 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010699
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010700 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10701 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10702 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10703 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010704
10705 Example :
10706 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10707 backend stats_localhost
10708 stats enable
10709 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10710
10711 Example :
10712 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10713 backend stats_auth
10714 stats enable
10715 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10716 stats admin if TRUE
10717
10718 Example :
10719 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10720 userlist stats-auth
10721 group admin users admin
10722 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10723 group readonly users haproxy
10724 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10725
10726 backend stats_auth
10727 stats enable
10728 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10729 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10730 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10731 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10732
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010733 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10734 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10735 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010736
10737
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010738stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10739 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010741 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010742 Arguments :
10743 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10744
10745 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10746
10747 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10748 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10749 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10750 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10751 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10752 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10753
10754 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10755 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10756 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010757 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010758
10759 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10760 report using "stats scope".
10761
10762 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10763 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10764 unobvious parameters.
10765
10766 Example :
10767 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10768 backend public_www
10769 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10770 stats enable
10771 stats hide-version
10772 stats scope .
10773 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010774 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010775 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10776 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10777
10778 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10779 backend private_monitoring
10780 stats enable
10781 stats uri /admin?stats
10782 stats refresh 5s
10783
10784 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10785
10786
10787stats enable
10788 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010790 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010791 Arguments : none
10792
10793 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10794 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10795 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10796 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10797 - stats auth : no authentication
10798 - stats scope : no restriction
10799
10800 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10801 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10802 unobvious parameters.
10803
10804 Example :
10805 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10806 backend public_www
10807 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10808 stats enable
10809 stats hide-version
10810 stats scope .
10811 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010812 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010813 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10814 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10815
10816 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10817 backend private_monitoring
10818 stats enable
10819 stats uri /admin?stats
10820 stats refresh 5s
10821
10822 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10823
10824
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010825stats hide-version
10826 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010828 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010829 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010830
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010831 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10832 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10833 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10834 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10835 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10836 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010837
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010838 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10839 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10840 unobvious parameters.
10841
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010842 Example :
10843 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10844 backend public_www
10845 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010846 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010847 stats hide-version
10848 stats scope .
10849 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010850 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010851 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10852 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010853
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010854 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10855 backend private_monitoring
10856 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010857 stats uri /admin?stats
10858 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010859
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010860 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010861
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010862
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010863stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10864 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10865 Access control for statistics
10866
10867 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10868 no | no | yes | yes
10869
10870 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10871 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10872 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10873 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10874 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10875 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10876
10877 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10878 instance.
10879
10880 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10881 about ACL usage.
10882
10883
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010884stats realm <realm>
10885 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010887 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010888 Arguments :
10889 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10890 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10891 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10892
10893 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10894 using a backslash ('\').
10895
10896 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10897 only related to authentication.
10898
10899 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10900 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10901 unobvious parameters.
10902
10903 Example :
10904 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10905 backend public_www
10906 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10907 stats enable
10908 stats hide-version
10909 stats scope .
10910 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010911 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010912 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10913 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10914
10915 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10916 backend private_monitoring
10917 stats enable
10918 stats uri /admin?stats
10919 stats refresh 5s
10920
10921 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10922
10923
10924stats refresh <delay>
10925 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010927 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010928 Arguments :
10929 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10930 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10931 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10932 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10933 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10934 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10935
10936 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10937 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10938 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010939 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010940
10941 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10942 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10943 unobvious parameters.
10944
10945 Example :
10946 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10947 backend public_www
10948 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10949 stats enable
10950 stats hide-version
10951 stats scope .
10952 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010953 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010954 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10955 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10956
10957 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10958 backend private_monitoring
10959 stats enable
10960 stats uri /admin?stats
10961 stats refresh 5s
10962
10963 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10964
10965
10966stats scope { <name> | "." }
10967 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010969 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010970 Arguments :
10971 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10972 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10973 section in which the statement appears.
10974
10975 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10976 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10977 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10978 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10979 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10980 exists.
10981
10982 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10983 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10984 unobvious parameters.
10985
10986 Example :
10987 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10988 backend public_www
10989 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10990 stats enable
10991 stats hide-version
10992 stats scope .
10993 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010994 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010995 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10996 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10997
10998 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10999 backend private_monitoring
11000 stats enable
11001 stats uri /admin?stats
11002 stats refresh 5s
11003
11004 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11005
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011006
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011007stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011008 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
11009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011010 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011011
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011012 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011013 description from global section is automatically used instead.
11014
11015 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11016 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
11017
11018 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11019 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011020 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011021
11022 Example :
11023 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11024 backend private_monitoring
11025 stats enable
11026 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
11027 stats uri /admin?stats
11028 stats refresh 5s
11029
11030 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11031 global section.
11032
11033
11034stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011035 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11037 yes | yes | yes | yes
11038 Arguments : none
11039
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011040 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011041 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11042 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11043 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11044 - IP (socket, server)
11045 - cookie (backend, server)
11046
11047 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11048 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011049 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011050
11051 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11052
11053
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011054stats show-modules
11055 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11057 yes | yes | yes | yes
11058 Arguments : none
11059
11060 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11061 values as a tooltip.
11062
11063 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11064 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11065 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11066
11067 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11068
11069
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011070stats show-node [ <name> ]
11071 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011073 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011074 Arguments:
11075 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11076 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11077
11078 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11079 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011080 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011081
11082 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11083 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11084 unobvious parameters.
11085
11086 Example:
11087 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11088 backend private_monitoring
11089 stats enable
11090 stats show-node Europe-1
11091 stats uri /admin?stats
11092 stats refresh 5s
11093
11094 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11095 section.
11096
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011097
11098stats uri <prefix>
11099 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011101 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011102 Arguments :
11103 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11104 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11105 query string.
11106
11107 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11108 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11109 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11110 possible to reach it in the application.
11111
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011112 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011113 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011114 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11115 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11116 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11117 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11118
11119 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11120 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11121 an address or a port to statistics only.
11122
11123 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11124 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11125 unobvious parameters.
11126
11127 Example :
11128 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11129 backend public_www
11130 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11131 stats enable
11132 stats hide-version
11133 stats scope .
11134 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011135 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011136 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11137 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11138
11139 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11140 backend private_monitoring
11141 stats enable
11142 stats uri /admin?stats
11143 stats refresh 5s
11144
11145 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11146
11147
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011148stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11149 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011151 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011152
11153 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011154 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011155 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011156 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011157 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11158
11159 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11160 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11161 the "stick-table" statement.
11162
11163 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11164 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11165 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11166 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11167 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11168
11169 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11170 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11171 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11172 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11173 transformation rules.
11174
11175 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11176 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11177 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11178 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11179 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11180 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11181 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11182
11183 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11184 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11185 ACL based conditions.
11186
11187 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11188 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11189 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11190 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11191
11192 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11193 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11194 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11195 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11196
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011197 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11198 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011199 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011200
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011201 Example :
11202 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11203 # last 30 minutes
11204 backend pop
11205 mode tcp
11206 balance roundrobin
11207 stick store-request src
11208 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11209 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11210 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11211
11212 backend smtp
11213 mode tcp
11214 balance roundrobin
11215 stick match src table pop
11216 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11217 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11218
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011219 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011220 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011221
11222
11223stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11224 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11226 no | no | yes | yes
11227
11228 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11229 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11230 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11231 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11232
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011233 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11234 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011235 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011236
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011237 Examples :
11238 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011239 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011240
11241 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11242 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11243 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11244
11245
11246 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11247 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11248 backend http
11249 mode http
11250 balance roundrobin
11251 stick on src table https
11252 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11253 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11254 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11255
11256 backend https
11257 mode tcp
11258 balance roundrobin
11259 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11260 stick on src
11261 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11262 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11263
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011264 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011265
11266
11267stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11268 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11270 no | no | yes | yes
11271
11272 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011273 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011274 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011275 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011276 server is selected.
11277
11278 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11279 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11280 the "stick-table" statement.
11281
11282 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11283 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11284 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11285 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11286 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11287 address.
11288
11289 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11290 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11291 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11292 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11293 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11294 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11295 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11296 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11297 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11298 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11299
11300 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11301 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11302 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11303 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11304 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11305 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11306 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11307
11308 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11309 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11310 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11311 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11312
11313 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11314 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11315 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11316 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11317 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11318 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011319 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11320 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11321 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11322 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11323 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11324 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011325
11326 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11327 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11328 the request.
11329
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011330 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11331 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011332 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011333
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011334 Example :
11335 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11336 # last 30 minutes
11337 backend pop
11338 mode tcp
11339 balance roundrobin
11340 stick store-request src
11341 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11342 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11343 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11344
11345 backend smtp
11346 mode tcp
11347 balance roundrobin
11348 stick match src table pop
11349 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11350 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11351
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011352 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011353 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011354
11355
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011356stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011357 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011358 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011359 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011361 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011362
11363 Arguments :
11364 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11365 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11366 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11367 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11368
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011369 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11370 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11371 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11372 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11373
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011374 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11375 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11376 instance.
11377
11378 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11379 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11380 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11381 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11382 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11383 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011384 to 32 characters.
11385
11386 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11387 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11388 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011389 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011390 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11391 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011392
11393 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011394 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11395 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011396 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11397 increase.
11398
11399 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011400 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11401 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11402 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011403
11404 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011405 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011406 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11407 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011408 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011409 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11410 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11411 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11412 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11413 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11414 parameter (see below).
11415
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011416 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11417 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11418 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11419 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11420 soft restart.
11421
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011422 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11423 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011424
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011425 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011426 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11427 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011428 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11429 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011430 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011431 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011432 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11433 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011434 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11435 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011436
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011437 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11438 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11439 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11440 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11441 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11442 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11443 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11444 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11445 token.
11446
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011447 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11448 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11449 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11450 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011451 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11452 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11453 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11454 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11455 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11456 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11457 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11458 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11459 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11460 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11461 types and their arguments.
11462
11463 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11464 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11465 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11466 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11467
11468 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11469 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11470 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011471 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011472
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011473 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11474 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11475 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011476 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011477 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011478 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011479
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011480 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11481 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11482 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11483 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11484
11485 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11486 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11487 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11488 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11489 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11490 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11491
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011492 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11493 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11494 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11495 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11496
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011497 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11498 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11499 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11500 they were received.
11501
11502 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11503 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11504 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11505 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11506 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11507
11508 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11509 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11510 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11511 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11512 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11513
11514 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11515 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11516 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11517
11518 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11519 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11520 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11521 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11522 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11523
11524 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11525 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11526 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11527 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11528 the client side.
11529
11530 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11531 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11532 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11533 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11534 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11535 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11536 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11537
11538 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11539 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11540 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11541 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11542 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11543 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011544 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011545
11546 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11547 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11548 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11549 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11550 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11551 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11552
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011553 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11554 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11555 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11556 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11557 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11558
11559 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11560 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11561 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11562 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11563 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11564 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11565
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011566 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011567 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011568 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11569 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11570
11571 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11572 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11573 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11574 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11575 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11576 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11577 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11578 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11579 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11580 recommended for better fairness.
11581
11582 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011583 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011584 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11585 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11586
11587 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11588 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11589 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11590 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11591 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11592 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11593 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11594 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11595 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11596 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011597
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011598 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11599 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011600 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11601 reference it.
11602
11603 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11604 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011605 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11606 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11607 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011608
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011609 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11610 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11611 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11612 something that can be ignored.
11613
11614 Example:
11615 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11616 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11617 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11618 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11619
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011620 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011621 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011622
11623
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011624stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011625 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11627 no | no | yes | yes
11628
11629 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011630 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011631 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011632 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011633 server is selected.
11634
11635 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11636 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11637 the "stick-table" statement.
11638
11639 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11640 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11641 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11642 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11643
11644 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11645 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11646 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11647 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11648 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11649 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011650 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011651 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11652 rules.
11653
11654 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11655 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11656 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11657 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11658 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11659 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11660 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11661
11662 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11663 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11664 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11665 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11666
11667 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11668 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11669 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11670 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11671 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11672 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011673 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11674 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11675 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11676 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11677 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11678 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11679 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11680 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11681 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011682
11683 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11684
11685 Example :
11686 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11687 backend https
11688 mode tcp
11689 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011690 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011691 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011692
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011693 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
William Lallemand858ed9a2023-12-07 15:00:58 +010011694 acl serverhello res.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011695
11696 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11697 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11698 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11699
11700 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11701 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011702
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011703 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11704 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11705 # at offset 44.
11706
11707 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011708 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011709
11710 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011711 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011712
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011713 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11714 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11715
11716 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11717 extraction.
11718
11719
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011720tcp-check comment <string>
11721 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11722 it fails.
11723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11724 yes | no | yes | yes
11725
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011726 Arguments :
11727 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11728 rule fails.
11729
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011730 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11731 user-friendly error reporting.
11732
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011733 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11734 "tcp-check expect".
11735
11736
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011737tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11738 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011739 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011740 Opens a new connection
11741 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011742 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011743
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011744 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011745 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11746
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011747 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011748 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011749
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011750 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011751 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11752 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011753 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011754
11755 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011756
11757 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11758
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011759 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11760
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011761 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11762
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011763 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11764
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011765 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11766 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11767 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11768 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11769
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011770 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11771 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11772 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11773 haproxy -vv.
11774
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011775 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011776
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011777 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11778 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11779 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11780
11781 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11782 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11783 of the sequence.
11784
11785 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11786 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11787 do.
11788
11789 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11790 unset-var or comment rules.
11791
11792 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011793 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11794 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11795 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11796 option tcp-check
11797 tcp-check connect
11798 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11799 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11800 tcp-check send \r\n
11801 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11802 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11803 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11804 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11805 tcp-check send \r\n
11806 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11807 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11808
11809 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11810 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011811 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011812 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11813 tcp-check connect port 143
11814 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11815 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11816
11817 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11818
11819
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011820tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011821 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011822 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011823 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011824 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011825 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011826 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011827
11828 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011829 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11830
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011831 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11832 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11833 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11834 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11835 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11836 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11837 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11838 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11839 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11840 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11841
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011842 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011843 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11844 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011845 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11846 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11847 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11848
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011849 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11850 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11851 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011852 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11853 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011854 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11855 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011856 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11857 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011858 By default "L7OK" is used.
11859
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011860 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11861 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011862 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11863 supported :
11864 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11865 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011866 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11867 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11868 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11869 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11870 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011871
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011872 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011873 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011874 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11875 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11876 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11877 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011878 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11879
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011880 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11881 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11882 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11883 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11884
11885 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11886 informational message reported in logs if an error
11887 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11888 log-format string.
11889
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011890 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11891 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11892 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11893 followed by some converters.
11894
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011895 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11896 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11897 with the usual backslash ('\').
11898 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011899 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011900 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11901 used upper or lower case.
11902
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011903 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11904
11905 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11906 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11907 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11908 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11909 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11910 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11911 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11912 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11913
11914 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11915 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11916 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11917 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11918 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11919 expression.
11920
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011921 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11922 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11923 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11924 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11925 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11926 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11927
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011928 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11929 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11930 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11931 this exact hexadecimal string.
11932 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11933
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011934 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11935 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11936 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11937 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11938 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11939 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11940 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11941 size.
11942
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011943 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11944 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11945 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11946 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11947 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11948 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11949 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11950 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11951 in a binary string before matching the response's
11952 buffer.
11953
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011954 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011955 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011956 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11957 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11958 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11959 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11960 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11961 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11962 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11963 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11964 the null character.
11965
11966 Examples :
11967 # perform a POP check
11968 option tcp-check
11969 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11970
11971 # perform an IMAP check
11972 option tcp-check
11973 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11974
11975 # look for the redis master server
11976 option tcp-check
11977 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011978 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011979 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11980 tcp-check expect string role:master
11981 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11982 tcp-check expect string +OK
11983
11984
11985 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011986 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011987
11988
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011989tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11990tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11991 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11992 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011993 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011994 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011995
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011996 Arguments :
11997 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11998
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011999 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
12000 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012001
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012002 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
12003 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012004
12005 Examples :
12006 # look for the redis master server
12007 option tcp-check
12008 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12009 tcp-check expect string role:master
12010
12011 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012012 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012013
12014
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012015tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
12016tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
12017 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
12018 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012019 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012020 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012021
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012022 Arguments :
12023 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012024
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012025 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
12026 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012027
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012028 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
12029 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12030 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012031
12032 Examples :
12033 # redis check in binary
12034 option tcp-check
12035 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12036 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12037
12038
12039 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012040 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012041
12042
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012043tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012044 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012045 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012046 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012047
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012048 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012049 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12050 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12051 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12052 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12053 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12054 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12055 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12056 and '-'.
12057
12058 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12059
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012060 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012061 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
12062
12063
12064tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012065 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012066 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012067 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012068
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012069 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012070 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12071 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12072 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12073 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12074 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12075 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12076 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12077 and '-'.
12078
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012079 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012080 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12081
12082
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012083tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12084 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12086 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012087 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012088 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12089 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012090
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012091 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012092
12093 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12094 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012095 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12096 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12097 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12098 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12099 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12100 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012101
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012102 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12103 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12104 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12105 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012106
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012107 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012108 - accept :
12109 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12110 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12111 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012112
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012113 - reject :
12114 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12115 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12116 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12117 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12118 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12119 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12120 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12121 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12122 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12123 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12124 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012125 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012126
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012127 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12128 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12129 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12130 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12131 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12132 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12133 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12134 hosts.
12135
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012136 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12137 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12138 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12139 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12140 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12141 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12142 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12143 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12144
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012145 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12146 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12147 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12148 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12149 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12150 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12151 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12152 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12153 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012154 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12155 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012156
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012157 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012158 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012159 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12160 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12161 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012162 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012163 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012164 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12165 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12166 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12167 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12168 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12169 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12170 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012171
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012172 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012173 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012174 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012175 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012176 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12177 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12178 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012179
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012180 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12181 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12182 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12183 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012184
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012185 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12186 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12187 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12188 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12189 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012190 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12191 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12192 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12193 layer7 information is extracted.
12194
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012195 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12196 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12197 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12198 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12199 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012200
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012201 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12202 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12203 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12204 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12205
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012206 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12207 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12208 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12209 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12210
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012211 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12212 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12213 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12214 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12215 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012216
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012217 - set-src <expr> :
12218 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12219 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12220 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012221 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012222
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012223 Arguments:
12224 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12225 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012226
12227 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012228 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12229
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012230 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12231 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012232
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012233 - set-src-port <expr> :
12234 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12235 expression.
12236
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012237 Arguments:
12238 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12239 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012240
12241 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012242 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12243
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012244 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12245 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12246 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012247
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012248 - set-dst <expr> :
12249 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12250 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12251 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12252 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12253 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12254
12255 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12256 followed by some converters.
12257
12258 Example:
12259
12260 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12261 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12262
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012263 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12264 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12265
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012266 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12267 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12268 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12269 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12270
12271
12272 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12273 followed by some converters.
12274
12275 Example:
12276
12277 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12278
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012279 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12280 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12281 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12282
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012283 - "silent-drop" :
12284 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012285 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012286 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12287 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12288 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12289 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12290 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012291 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12292 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012293 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12294 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012295 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012296 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12297 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12298 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12299 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12300
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012301 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12302 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12303 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012304
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012305 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12306 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12307 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012308
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012309 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012310 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012311 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012312
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012313 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12314 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12315 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012316
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012317 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012318 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12319 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012320
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012321 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12322
12323 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12324
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012325 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12326
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012327 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012328
12329
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012330tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12331 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012333 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012334 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012335 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12336 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012337
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012338 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012339
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012340 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012341 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12342 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012343 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12344 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012345
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012346 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12347 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12348 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12349 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012350 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012351 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012352 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12353 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12354 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12355 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012356 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012357 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012358
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012359 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12360 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12361 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12362 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012363
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012364 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012365 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012366 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012367 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12368 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012369 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012370 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012371 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012372 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012373 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012374 - set-dst <expr>
12375 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012376 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012377 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012378 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012379 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012380 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012381 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012382
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012383 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12384 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012385 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12386 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012387
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012388 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12389 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12390 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12391 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12392 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12393 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012395 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012396 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12397 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012398
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012399 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12400 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12401 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12402 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12403 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12404 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12405
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012406 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012407 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12408 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12409 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12410 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12411 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12412 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12413 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12414 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12415 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12416 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012417
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012418 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012419 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12420 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12421 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012422
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012423 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12424 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12425
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012426 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012427 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12428 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012429
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012430 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12431 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012432 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012433 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12434 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012435 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012436 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012437 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012438 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12439 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012440 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012441 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12442 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012443
12444 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12445 followed by some converters.
12446
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012447 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012448 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12449 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12450 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12451 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12452 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12453 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012454 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012455 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12456 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12457
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012458 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12459
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012460 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12461 <var-name>.
12462
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012463 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12464 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12465 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12466 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12467 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12468
12469 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12470 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12471 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12472 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12473 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12474 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12475 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12476 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12477 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12478 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12479 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12480
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012481 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12482 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12483 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12484 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12485 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12486
12487 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12488
12489 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12490
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012491 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12492 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12493 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12494 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12495 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12496 evaluated.
12497
12498 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONdf332122022-10-05 18:09:33 +020012499 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012500
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012501 Example:
12502
12503 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012504 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012505
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012506 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012507 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012508 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012509 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12510 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012511 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012512 tcp-request content reject
12513
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012514 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12515 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12516 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12517 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12518 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12519 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12520 ...
12521 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12522
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012523 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012524 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12525 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012526 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012527 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012528
12529 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12530 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012531 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012532 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012533 tcp-request content reject
12534
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012535 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012536 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012537 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012538 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012539 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12540 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012541
12542 Example:
12543 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12544 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012545 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012546
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012547 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012548 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012549
12550 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012551 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012552 # protecting all our sites
12553 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012554 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12555 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012556 ...
12557 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12558
12559 backend http_dynamic
12560 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012561 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012562 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012563 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012564 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012565 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012566 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012568 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012569
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012570 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12571 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012572
12573
12574tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12575 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012577 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012578 Arguments :
12579 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12580 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12581 as explained at the top of this document.
12582
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012583 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012584 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12585 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12586 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12587 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12588
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012589 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12590 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12591 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12592 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12593
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012594 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012595 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012596 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012597 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012598 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012599 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12600 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12601 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012602
Christopher Faulet3e2a39e2023-05-16 08:15:12 +020012603 Note the inspection delay is shortened if an connection error or shutdown is
12604 experienced or if the request buffer appears as full.
12605
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012606 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12607 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12608 it pass through unaffected.
12609
12610 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12611 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12612 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012613 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012614 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12615 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012616 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12617 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12618 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012619
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012620 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012621 "timeout client".
12622
12623
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012624tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12625 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12627 no | no | yes | yes
12628 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012629 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12630 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012631
12632 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12633
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012634 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012635 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12636 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012637 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12638 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012639
12640 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12641
12642 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12643 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12644 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12645 inserted.
12646
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012647 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012648 - accept :
12649 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12650 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12651 the rules evaluation.
12652
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012653 - close :
12654 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12655 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12656 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12657 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12658 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12659 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012660 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012661 protocols.
12662
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012663 - reject :
12664 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12665 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012666 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012667
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012668 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012669 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012670
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012671 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12672 Unsets a variable.
12673
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012674 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12675 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12676 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12677 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12678
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012679 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12680 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12681 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12682 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12683
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012684 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12685 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12686 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12687 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12688 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012689
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012690 - "silent-drop" :
12691 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012692 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012693 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12694 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12695 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12696 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12697 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012698 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12699 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012700 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12701 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012702 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012703 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12704 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12705 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12706 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12707
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012708 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12709 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12710
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012711 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12712 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12713 for changing the default action to a reject.
12714
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012715 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12716 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12717 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12718 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012719 period.
12720
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012721 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12722 declared inline.
12723
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012724 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12725 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012726 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012727 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12728 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012729 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012730 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012731 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012732 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12733 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012734 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012735 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12736 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012737
12738 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12739 followed by some converters.
12740
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012741 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12742 <var-name>.
12743
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012744 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12745 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12746 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12747 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12748 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12749
12750 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12751
12752 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12753
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012754 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12755
12756 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12757
12758
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012759tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12760 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12762 no | yes | yes | no
12763 Arguments :
12764 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12765 below.
12766
12767 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12768
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012769 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012770 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12771 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12772 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12773 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12774 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12775 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12776 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012777 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012778 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12779 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12780 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12781 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12782 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12783 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12784 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12785 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12786 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12787 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12788 instead.
12789
12790 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12791 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12792 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12793 rules which may be inserted.
12794
12795 Several types of actions are supported :
12796 - accept : the request is accepted
12797 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12798 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12799 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012800 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012801 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012802 - set-dst <expr>
12803 - set-dst-port <expr>
12804 - set-src <expr>
12805 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012806 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012807 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012808 - silent-drop
12809
12810 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12811 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12812 sections for a complete description.
12813
12814 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12815 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12816 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12817
12818 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12819 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12820 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12821 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12822 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12823
12824 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12825 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12826
12827 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12828 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12829 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12830
12831 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12832 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12833 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12834
12835 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12836 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12837 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12838
12839 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12840 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12841 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12842
12843 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12844
12845 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12846
12847
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012848tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12849 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12851 no | no | yes | yes
12852 Arguments :
12853 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12854 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12855 as explained at the top of this document.
12856
12857 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12858
12859
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012860timeout check <timeout>
12861 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12862 established.
12863
12864 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12865 yes | no | yes | yes
12866 Arguments:
12867 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12868 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12869 as explained at the top of this document.
12870
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012871 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012872 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012873 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012874 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012875 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12876 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12877 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012878
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012879 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012880 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12881
12882 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12883 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012884 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012885
12886 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12887 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12888 forget about it.
12889
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012890 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12891 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012892
12893
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012894timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012895 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12897 yes | yes | yes | no
12898 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012899 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012900 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12901 as explained at the top of this document.
12902
12903 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12904 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12905 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012906 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12907 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12908 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12909 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012910 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12911 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12912 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012913 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012914 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012915 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12916 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012917 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12918 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012919
12920 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12921 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12922 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12923 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012924 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012925 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12926
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012927 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012928
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012929
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012930timeout client-fin <timeout>
12931 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12933 yes | yes | yes | no
12934 Arguments :
12935 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12936 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12937 as explained at the top of this document.
12938
12939 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12940 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12941 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12942 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12943 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12944 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12945 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012946 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12947 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12948 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012949
12950 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12951 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12952 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12953
12954 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12955
12956
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012957timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012958 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12960 yes | no | yes | yes
12961 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012962 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012963 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12964 as explained at the top of this document.
12965
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012966 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012967 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012968 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012969 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012970 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12971 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012972
12973 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12974 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12975 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12976 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012977 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012978 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12979
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012980 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012981
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012982
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012983timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12984 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12986 yes | yes | yes | yes
12987 Arguments :
12988 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12989 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12990 as explained at the top of this document.
12991
12992 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12993 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12994 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12995 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12996 once the request has started to present itself.
12997
12998 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12999 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13000 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13001 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13002 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13003
13004 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13005 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13006 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13007 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13008
13009 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13010 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013011 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013012 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13013 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013014 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013015
13016 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13017 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13018 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13019 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13020
13021 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13022
13023
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013024timeout http-request <timeout>
13025 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013027 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013028 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013029 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013030 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13031 as explained at the top of this document.
13032
13033 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13034 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13035 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13036 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13037 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13038 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13039 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013040 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13041 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13042 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13043 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013044 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013045 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13046 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013047
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013048 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13049 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13050 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13051 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13052 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013053 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013054
13055 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13056 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013057 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013058 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13059 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13060
13061 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013062 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13063 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13064 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013065
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013066 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013067 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013068
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013069
13070timeout queue <timeout>
13071 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13073 yes | no | yes | yes
13074 Arguments :
13075 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13076 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13077 as explained at the top of this document.
13078
13079 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13080 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13081 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13082 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13083 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13084
13085 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13086 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13087 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13088 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13089
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013090 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013091
13092
13093timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013094 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13096 yes | no | yes | yes
13097 Arguments :
13098 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13099 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13100 as explained at the top of this document.
13101
13102 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13103 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13104 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13105 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13106 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13107 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13108 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13109
13110 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13111 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13112 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13113 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13114 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013115 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013116 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013117 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13118 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013119 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13120 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013121
13122 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13123 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13124 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13125 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013126 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013127 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13128
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013129 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013130
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013131
13132timeout server-fin <timeout>
13133 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13135 yes | no | yes | yes
13136 Arguments :
13137 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13138 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13139 as explained at the top of this document.
13140
13141 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13142 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13143 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13144 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13145 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13146 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13147 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13148 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13149 situations, it should not be needed.
13150
13151 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13152 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13153 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13154
13155 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13156
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013157
13158timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013159 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13161 yes | yes | yes | yes
13162 Arguments :
13163 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13164 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13165 as explained at the top of this document.
13166
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013167 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13168 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13169 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013170
13171 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13172 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13173 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13174 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013175 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013176
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013177 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013178
13179
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013180timeout tunnel <timeout>
13181 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13183 yes | no | yes | yes
13184 Arguments :
13185 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13186 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13187 as explained at the top of this document.
13188
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013189 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013190 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13191 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13192 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013193 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13194 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013195 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13196 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13197 specified.
13198
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013199 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13200 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13201 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13202 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13203 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13204 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13205 state.
13206
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013207 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13208 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13209 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13210 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013211 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013212
13213 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13214 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13215 forget about it.
13216
13217 Example :
13218 defaults http
13219 option http-server-close
13220 timeout connect 5s
13221 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013222 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013223 timeout server 30s
13224 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13225
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013226 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013227
13228
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013229transparent (deprecated)
13230 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013232 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013233 Arguments : none
13234
13235 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13236 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13237 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13238 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13239 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13240 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13241 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13242 appropriate server.
13243
13244 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13245
13246 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13247 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13248
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013249 See also: "option transparent"
13250
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013251unique-id-format <string>
13252 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13254 yes | yes | yes | no
13255 Arguments :
13256 <string> is a log-format string.
13257
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013258 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13259 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13260 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13261 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013262
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013263 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013264 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013265 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13266 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13267 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13268 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13269 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13270 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013271
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013272 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13273 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013274
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013275 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013276
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013277 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013278
13279 will generate:
13280
13281 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13282
13283 See also: "unique-id-header"
13284
13285unique-id-header <name>
13286 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13288 yes | yes | yes | no
13289 Arguments :
13290 <name> is the name of the header.
13291
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013292 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13293 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013294
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013295 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013296
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013297 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013298 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13299
13300 will generate:
13301
13302 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13303
13304 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013305
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013306use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013307 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13309 no | yes | yes | no
13310 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013311 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13312 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013313
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013314 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13315 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013316
13317 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13318 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13319 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013320 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013321 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013322 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13323 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013324
13325 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13326 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13327 assign the backend.
13328
13329 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13330 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13331 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13332 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13333 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13334 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13335
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013336 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013337 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013338 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13339 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13340 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13341
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013342 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13343 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13344 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13345 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13346 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13347 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13348 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13349 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13350 cannot be forced from the request.
13351
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013352 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013353 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13354 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13355
13356 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13357 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013358
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013359use-fcgi-app <name>
13360 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13362 no | no | yes | yes
13363 Arguments :
13364 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13365
13366 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013367
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013368use-server <server> if <condition>
13369use-server <server> unless <condition>
13370 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13372 no | no | yes | yes
13373 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013374 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13375 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013376
13377 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13378
13379 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13380 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13381 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13382
13383 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13384 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13385 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13386 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13387 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13388 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13389 matches will assign the server.
13390
13391 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13392 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13393 with the next rules until one matches.
13394
13395 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13396 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13397 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13398 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13399
13400 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13401 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13402 stripped.
13403
13404 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13405 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013406 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013407 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013408 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013409
13410 Example :
13411 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013412 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013413 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013414 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013415 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013416 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013417 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013418 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13419 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13420
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013421 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13422 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13423 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13424 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013425 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013426 and we fall back to load balancing.
13427
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013428 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013429
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013430
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100134315. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013432--------------------------
13433
13434The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13435depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13436settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13437written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13438described in this section.
13439
13440
134415.1. Bind options
13442-----------------
13443
13444The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13445as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13446no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13447parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13448while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13449provided immediately after the setting name.
13450
13451The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13452
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013453accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13454 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13455 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13456 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13457 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13458 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13459 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13460 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13461 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13462 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013463 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13464 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13465 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013466
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013467accept-proxy
13468 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013469 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13470 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013471 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13472 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13473 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13474 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013475 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013476 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13477 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013478 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13479 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013480
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013481allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013482 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013483 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013484 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013485 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13486 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013487
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013488alpn <protocols>
13489 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13490 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13491 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013492 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013493 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013494 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13495 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13496 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13497 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13498 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13499 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13500 preference, like below :
13501
13502 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013503
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013504backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013505 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013506 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13507
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013508curves <curves>
13509 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13510 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13511 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13512 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13513 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13514 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13515
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013516ecdhe <named curve>
13517 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013518 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13519 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013520
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013521ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013522 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13523 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13524 client's certificate.
13525
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013526ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13528 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13529 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13530 error is ignored.
13531
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013532ca-sign-file <cafile>
13533 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13534 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13535 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13536 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13537 'generate-certificates' for details.
13538
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013539ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013540 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13541 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13542 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13543 'generate-certificates' for details.
13544
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013545ca-verify-file <cafile>
13546 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13547 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13548 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13549 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13550 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13551
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013552ciphers <ciphers>
13553 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13554 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013555 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013556 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013557 information and recommendations see e.g.
13558 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13559 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13560 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13561
13562ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13563 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13564 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
William Lallemand6b0dea72024-03-11 15:48:14 +010013565 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13566 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
13567 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13568 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
13569 This setting might accept TLSv1.2 ciphersuites however this is an
13570 undocumented behavior and not recommended as it could be inconsistent or buggy.
13571 The default TLSv1.3 ciphersuites of OpenSSL are:
13572 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
13573
13574 TLSv1.3 only supports 5 ciphersuites:
13575
13576 - TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
13577 - TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
13578 - TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256
13579 - TLS_AES_128_CCM_SHA256
13580 - TLS_AES_128_CCM_8_SHA256
13581
13582 Example:
13583 ciphers ECDHE-RSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384:ECDHE-RSA-CHACHA20-POLY1305:ECDHE-RSA-AES128-GCM-SHA256
13584 ciphersuites TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013585
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013586crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013587 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13588 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013589 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13590 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013591
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013592crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013593 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13594 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13595 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13596 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13597 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013598 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13599 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013600
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013601 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13602 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13603
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013604 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13605 are loaded.
13606
13607 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013608 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13609 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13610 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13611 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13612 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13613 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13614 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
William Lallemand929da3e2023-04-04 16:28:58 +020013615 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If an empty directory is used,
13616 HAProxy will not start unless the "strict-sni" keyword is used.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013617
13618 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13619 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13620 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13621 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013622 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13623 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013624
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013625 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013626
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013627 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013628 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013629 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13630 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013631 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13632 clients).
13633
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013634 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013635 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13636 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13637 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13638 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13639 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13640 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13641 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13642 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13643 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13644 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13645 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13646 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13647
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013648 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013649 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13650 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13651 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13652 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13653
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013654 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13655 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13656 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13657 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013658
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013659 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13660 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13661 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013662
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013663crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013664 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013665 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013666 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013667 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013668
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013669crt-list <file>
13670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013671 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13672 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013673
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013674 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13675
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013676 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13677 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13678 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13679 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13680 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013681
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013682 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013683 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13684 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13685 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13686 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13687 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013688 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13689 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13690 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013691
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013692 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13693 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13694 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013695
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013696 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13697
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013698 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013699 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013700 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13701 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13702 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13703 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13704 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13705 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013706
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013707 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013708 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013709 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013710 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013711 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013712 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013713
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013714defer-accept
13715 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13716 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13717 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013718 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013719 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13720 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13721 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13722 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13723 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13724 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13725 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13726
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013727expose-fd listeners
13728 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13729 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013730 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13731 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013732 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013733
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013734force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013735 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013736 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013737 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013738 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013739
13740force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013741 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013742 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013743 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013744
13745force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013746 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013747 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013748 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013749
13750force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013751 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013752 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013753 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013754
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013755force-tlsv13
13756 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13757 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013758 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013759
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013760generate-certificates
13761 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13762 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13763 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13764 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13765 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13766 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13767 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13768 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13769 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13770 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13771 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13772
13773 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13774 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013775 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013776 certificate is used many times.
13777
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013778gid <gid>
13779 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13780 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13781 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13782 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13783 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13784
13785group <group>
13786 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13787 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13788 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13789 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13790 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13791
13792id <id>
13793 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13794 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13795 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13796 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13797
13798interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013799 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13800 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13801 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13802 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13803 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13804 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013805 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13806 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13807 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13808 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13809 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13810 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013811
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013812level <level>
13813 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13814 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13815 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013816 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013817 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13818 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13819 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013820 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013821 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013822 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013823 all counters).
13824
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013825severity-output <format>
13826 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13827 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13828 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13829 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13830 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13831 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13832 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13833 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13834 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13835 rfc5424 convention.
13836
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013837maxconn <maxconn>
13838 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13839 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13840 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13841 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13842 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13843 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13844 eat all memory.
13845
13846mode <mode>
13847 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13848 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13849 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13850 UNIX sockets.
13851
13852mss <maxseg>
13853 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13854 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13855 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13856 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13857 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13858 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13859 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13860 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13861 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13862 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13863 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13864
13865name <name>
13866 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13867 page.
13868
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013869namespace <name>
13870 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13871 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13872 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13873 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13874
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013875nice <nice>
13876 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13877 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13878 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13879 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13880 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13881 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13882 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13883 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13884 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13885 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13886 one for an RDP socket.
13887
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013888no-ca-names
13889 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13890 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013891 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013892
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013893no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013895 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013896 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013897 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013898 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13899 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013900
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013901no-tls-tickets
13902 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13903 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13904 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013905 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13906 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013907 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13908 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13909 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013910
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013911no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013912 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013913 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013914 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013915 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013916 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13917 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013918
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013919no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013921 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013922 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013923 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013924 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13925 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013926
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013927no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013928 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013929 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013930 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013931 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013932 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13933 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013934
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013935no-tlsv13
13936 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13937 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13938 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13939 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013940 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13941 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013942
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013943npn <protocols>
13944 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13945 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13946 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013947 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013948 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013949 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13950 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13951 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13952 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13953 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013954
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013955prefer-client-ciphers
13956 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13957 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13958 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013959 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13960 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13961 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013962
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013963process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013964 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013965 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013966 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013967 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13968 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13969 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13970 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013971 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013972 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13973 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13974 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13975 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13976 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013977
13978 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13979
13980 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13981 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13982 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13983 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13984 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13985 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13986 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13987 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013988
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013989proto <name>
13990 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13991 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13992 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013993 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13994 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13995
13996 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13997 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13998 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13999 also reported (flag=HTX).
14000
14001 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14002 a bind line :
14003
14004 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14005 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14006 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14007
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014008 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014009 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014010 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014011 h2" on the bind line.
14012
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014013ssl
14014 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014015 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014016 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
14017 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020014018 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
14019 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014020
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014021ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14022 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014023 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
14024 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
14025 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014026 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14027
14028ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014029 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
14030 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
14031 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
14032 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014033
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014034strict-sni
14035 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
14036 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
William Lallemand929da3e2023-04-04 16:28:58 +020014037 a certificate. The default certificate is not used. This option also allows
14038 to start without any certificate on a bind line, so an empty directory could
14039 be used and filled later from the stats socket.
14040 See the "crt" option for more information. See "add ssl crt-list" command in
14041 the management guide.
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014042
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014043tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014044 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014045 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014046 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014047 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014048 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14049 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14050 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14051 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14052 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14053 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14054 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14055
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014056tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014057 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014058 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14059 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14060 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14061 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14062 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14063 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14064 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014065 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14066 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14067 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014068
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014069tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14070 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014071 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14072 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14073 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14074 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14075 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14076 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14077 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14078 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14079 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14080 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014081 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14082 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14083
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014084transparent
14085 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14086 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14087 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14088 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14089 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14090 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14091 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14092 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14093 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14094 so check for support with your vendor.
14095
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014096v4v6
14097 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14098 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14099 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14100 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014101 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014102
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014103v6only
14104 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14105 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14106 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014107 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14108 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014109
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014110uid <uid>
14111 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14112 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14113 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14114 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14115 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14116
14117user <user>
14118 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14119 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14120 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14121 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14122 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14123
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014124verify [none|optional|required]
14125 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14126 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14127 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14128 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14129 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014130 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14131 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14132 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14133 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014134
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200141355.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014136------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014137
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014138The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14139which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14140arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14141settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14142after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14143Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14144address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014146 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014147 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014148
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014149Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14150keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014152The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014153
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014154addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014155 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014156 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14157 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14158 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14159 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14160 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014161
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014162agent-check
14163 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014164 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014165 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14166 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14167 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014168
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014169 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014170 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014171 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014172 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14173 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014174
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014175 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14176 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14177 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14178 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14179 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014180
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014181 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014182 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014183
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014184 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14185 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14186 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014187
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014188 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14189 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14190 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014191
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014192 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014193 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14194 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14195 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14196 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014197 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014198 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014199
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014200 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14201 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014202
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014203 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14204 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14205 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14206 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14207 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14208 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14209 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14210 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14211 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014212
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014213 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14214 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014215 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14216 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14217 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014218 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014219
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014220 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014221 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014222
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014223agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014224 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014225 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14226 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14227 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14228 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14229
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014230agent-inter <delay>
14231 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14232 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14233
14234 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14235 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14236 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14237 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14238 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14239 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14240 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14241 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14242 of backends use the same servers.
14243
14244 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14245
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014246agent-addr <addr>
14247 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14248
14249 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014250 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014251 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14252 hostname, it will be resolved.
14253
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014254agent-port <port>
14255 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14256
14257 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14258
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014259allow-0rtt
14260 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014261 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14262 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014263
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014264alpn <protocols>
14265 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14266 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14267 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014268 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014269 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14270 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14271 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14272 now obsolete NPN extension.
14273 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14274 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14275
14276 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14277
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014278 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014280backup
14281 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14282 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14283 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14284 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014285 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14286 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014287
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014288ca-file <cafile>
14289 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14290 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14291 server's certificate.
14292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014293check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014294 This option enables health checks on a server:
14295 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14296 considered available.
14297 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14298 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14299 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14300 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14301 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14302 set.
14303 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14304 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14305 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14306 exchanges succeed.
14307
14308 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14309 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14310 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14311 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14312 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014313 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014314 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14315
14316 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14317 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14318
14319 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14320 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14321
14322 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14323 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14324 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14325 available.
14326
14327 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14328 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14329 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14330
14331 Example:
14332 # simple tcp check
14333 backend foo
14334 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14335 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14336 backend foo
14337 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14338 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14339 backend foo
14340 option tcp-check
14341 tcp-check connect
14342 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014343
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014344check-send-proxy
14345 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14346 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14347 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14348 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14349 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14350 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14351 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14352
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014353check-alpn <protocols>
14354 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14355 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14356 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14357
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014358check-proto <name>
14359 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14360 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14361 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014362 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14363 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14364
14365 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14366 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14367 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14368 also reported (flag=HTX).
14369
14370 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14371 directive on a server line:
14372
14373 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14374 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14375 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14376 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14377
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014378 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014379 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14380 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14381
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014382check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014383 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014384 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14385 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014386
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014387check-ssl
14388 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14389 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14390 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14391 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014392 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014393 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14394 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014395 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014396 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14397 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014398
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014399check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014400 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014401 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14402 for normal traffic.
14403
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014404ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014405 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14406 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14407 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014408 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14409 information and recommendations see e.g.
14410 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14411 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14412 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014413
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014414ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14415 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14416 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
William Lallemand6b0dea72024-03-11 15:48:14 +010014417 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14418 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
14419 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14420 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14421 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014423cookie <value>
14424 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14425 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14426 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14427 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14428 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14429 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14430 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14431
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014432crl-file <crlfile>
14433 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14434 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14435 to verify server's certificate.
14436
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014437crt <cert>
14438 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14439 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14440 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14441 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14442 certificate request.
14443
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014444 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14445 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14446 option is set accordingly).
14447
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014448disabled
14449 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14450 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14451 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14452 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14453 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014454 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014455
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014456enabled
14457 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14458 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14459 default value.
14460 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14461 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014463error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014464 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14465 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14466 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014467
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014468 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014469
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014470fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014471 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14472 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14473 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14474
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014475force-sslv3
14476 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14477 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014478 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014479 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014480
14481force-tlsv10
14482 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014483 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014484 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014485
14486force-tlsv11
14487 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014488 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014489 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014490
14491force-tlsv12
14492 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014493 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014494 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014495
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014496force-tlsv13
14497 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14498 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014499 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014501id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014502 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14503 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14504 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014505
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014506init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14507 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14508 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014509 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014510 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14511 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14512 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14513 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14514 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14515 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14516 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14517 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14518 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014519 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014520 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14521 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14522 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14523 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14524 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14525 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014526 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014527
14528 Example:
14529 defaults
14530 # never fail on address resolution
14531 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014533inter <delay>
14534fastinter <delay>
14535downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014536 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14537 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14538 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14539 between checks depending on the server state :
14540
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014541 Server state | Interval used
14542 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14543 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14544 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14545 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14546 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14547 or yet unchecked. |
14548 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14549 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14550 | "inter" otherwise.
14551 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014553 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14554 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14555 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14556 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014557 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14558 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14559 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14560 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14561 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014562
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014563log-proto <logproto>
14564 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14565 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14566 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14567 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14568
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014569maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014570 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14571 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014572 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14573 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014574 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14575 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14576 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14577 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14578
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014579 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14580 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14581 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14582 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14583 than 50 concurrent requests.
14584
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014585maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014586 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14587 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14588 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14589 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014590 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14591 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14592 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14593 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14594 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14595 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14596 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014597
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014598max-reuse <count>
14599 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14600 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14601 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14602 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14603 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14604 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14605 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14606 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14607
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014608minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014609 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14610 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14611 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14612 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14613 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14614 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014615 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014616 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014617
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014618namespace <name>
14619 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14620 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14621 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14622 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14623
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014624no-agent-check
14625 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14626 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14627 default value.
14628 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14629 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14630
14631no-backup
14632 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14633 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14634 default value.
14635 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14636 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14637
14638no-check
14639 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14640 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14641 default value.
14642 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14643 "default-server" "check" setting.
14644
14645no-check-ssl
14646 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14647 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14648 default value.
14649 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14650 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14651
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014652no-send-proxy
14653 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14654 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14655 default value.
14656 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14657 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14658
14659no-send-proxy-v2
14660 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14661 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14662 default value.
14663 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14664 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14665
14666no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14667 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14668 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14669 default value.
14670 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14671 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14672
14673no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14674 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14675 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14676 default value.
14677 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14678 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14679
14680no-ssl
14681 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14682 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14683 default value.
14684 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14685 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14686
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014687 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14688 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14689 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14690
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014691no-ssl-reuse
14692 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14693 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14694 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14695 and for paranoid users.
14696
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014697no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014698 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14699 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014700 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014701
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014702 Supported in default-server: No
14703
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014704no-tls-tickets
14705 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14706 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14707 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014708 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14709 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014710 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14711 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14712 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014713 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014714
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014715no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014716 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014717 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14718 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014719 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14720 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014721 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014722
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014723 Supported in default-server: No
14724
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014725no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014726 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014727 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14728 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014729 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14730 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014731 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014732
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014733 Supported in default-server: No
14734
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014735no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014736 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014737 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14738 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014739 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14740 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014741 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014742
14743 Supported in default-server: No
14744
14745no-tlsv13
14746 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14747 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14748 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14749 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14750 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014751 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014752
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014753 Supported in default-server: No
14754
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014755no-verifyhost
14756 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14757 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14758 default value.
14759 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14760 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014761
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014762no-tfo
14763 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14764 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14765 default value.
14766 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14767 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14768
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014769non-stick
14770 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14771 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14772 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14773
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014774npn <protocols>
14775 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14776 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14777 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014778 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014779 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14780 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14781 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014783observe <mode>
14784 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14785 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14786 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14787 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14788 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14789 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014790 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014791
14792 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014794on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014795 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14796 Currently, four modes are available:
14797 - fastinter: force fastinter
14798 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14799 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14800 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14801 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14802
14803 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14804
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014805on-marked-down <action>
14806 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14807 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014808 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14809 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14810 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14811 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14812 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14813 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14814 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14815 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014816
14817 Actions are disabled by default
14818
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014819on-marked-up <action>
14820 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14821 Currently one action is available:
14822 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14823 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14824 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14825 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014826 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14827 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014828 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14829 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14830
14831 Actions are disabled by default
14832
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014833pool-low-conn <max>
14834 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14835 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14836 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14837 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14838 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14839 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14840 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14841 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14842 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14843 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014844 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14845 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14846 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14847 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014848
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014849pool-max-conn <max>
14850 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14851 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14852 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14853 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14854 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14855 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14856
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014857pool-purge-delay <delay>
14858 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014859 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014860 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014861
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014862port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014863 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014864 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14865 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14866 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14867 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14868 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014869
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014870proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014871 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14872 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14873 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014874 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14875 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14876
14877 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14878 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14879 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14880 also reported (flag=HTX).
14881
14882 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14883 a server line :
14884
14885 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14886 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14887 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14888 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14889
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014890 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014891 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14892
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014893 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14894
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014895redir <prefix>
14896 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14897 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14898 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14899 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14900 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14901 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14902 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14903 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014904 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014905 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014906 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14907 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14908 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14909 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14910
14911 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014913rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014914 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14915 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14916 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14917
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014918resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14919 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14920 server.
14921
14922 Available options:
14923
14924 * allow-dup-ip
14925 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14926 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14927 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14928 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14929 For such case, simply enable this option.
14930 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14931
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014932 * ignore-weight
14933 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14934 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14935 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14936
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014937 * prevent-dup-ip
14938 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14939 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14940 same fqdn.
14941 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14942
14943 Example:
14944 backend b_myapp
14945 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14946 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14947 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14948
14949 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14950 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14951 it
14952 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14953 different address
14954
14955 Default value: not set
14956
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014957resolve-prefer <family>
14958 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14959 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14960 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14961 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14962
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014963 Default value: ipv6
14964
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014965 Example:
14966
14967 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014968
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014969resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014970 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014971 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014972 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014973 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14974 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014975 configured network, another address is selected.
14976
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014977 Example:
14978
14979 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014980
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014981resolvers <id>
14982 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14983 hostname.
14984
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014985 Example:
14986
14987 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014988
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014989 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014990
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014991send-proxy
14992 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14993 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14994 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14995 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014996 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14997 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14998 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14999 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015000 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015001 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
15002 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
15003 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
15004 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
15005 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015006 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
15007 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015008
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015009send-proxy-v2
15010 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
15011 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15012 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15013 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020015014 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
15015 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
15016 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
15017 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015018
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015019proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010015020 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
15021 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
15022
15023 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
15024 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
15025 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
15026 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
15027 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
15028 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
15029 connection is supported).
15030 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
15031 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
15032 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
15033 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
15034 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
15035 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
15036 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015037
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015038send-proxy-v2-ssl
15039 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15040 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15041 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15042 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15043 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15044 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15045 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015046 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15047 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015048
15049send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15050 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15051 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15052 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15053 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15054 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15055 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15056 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15057 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015058 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15059 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015060
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015061slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015062 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15063 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15064 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15065 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15066 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15067 parameters :
15068
15069 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15070 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15071
15072 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15073 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15074 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15075 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15076
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015077 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015078 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15079 seen as failed.
15080
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015081sni <expression>
15082 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15083 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15084 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010015085 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
15086 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
15087 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
15088 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015089 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015090 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015091 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15092 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015093
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015094source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015095source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015096source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015097 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15098 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15099 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15100 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15101
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015102 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15103 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15104 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15105 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15106 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15107 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15108 server.
15109
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015110 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15111 specifying the source address without port(s).
15112
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015113ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015114 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15115 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15116 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15117 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15118 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15119 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015120 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15121 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015122
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015123ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15124 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15125 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15126 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15127
15128ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15129 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15130 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15131 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15132
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015133ssl-reuse
15134 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15135 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15136 default value.
15137 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15138 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15139
15140stick
15141 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15142 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15143 default value.
15144 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15145 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015146
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015147socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015148 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015149 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15150 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15151
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015152tcp-ut <delay>
15153 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015154 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015155 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015156 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015157 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15158 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15159 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15160 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15161 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15162 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15163 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15164 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15165 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15166
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015167tfo
15168 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15169 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15170 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15171 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015172 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015173 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015174
Willy Tarreau42bd5cb2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010015175track [<backend>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015176 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15177 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15178 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
Willy Tarreau42bd5cb2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010015179 enabled. If <backend> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015180 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15181
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015182tls-tickets
15183 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15184 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15185 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015186 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15187 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15188 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015189 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015190 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015191
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015192verify [none|required]
15193 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015194 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015195 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15196 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015197 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015198 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15199 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15200 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15201 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15202 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15203 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15204 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15205 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015206
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015207verifyhost <hostname>
15208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015209 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15210 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15211 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15212 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15213 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15214 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15215 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15216 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015217
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015218weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015219 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15220 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15221 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015222 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15223 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15224 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15225 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15226 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15227 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015228
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015229ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15230 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15231 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15232 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15233
15234 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15235 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15236 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15237 server ALPN contains it.
15238
15239 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15240 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15241 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15242 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15243
15244 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15245 favor of the ALPN extension.
15246
15247 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15248
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015249
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152505.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15251-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015252
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015253HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15254using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015255configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015256This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15257can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15258workload.
15259This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15260resolution at run time.
15261Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15262carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15263
15264
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152655.3.1. Global overview
15266----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015267
15268As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15269different steps of the process life:
15270
15271 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15272 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15273 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15274
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015275 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15276 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015277
15278A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15279 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15280 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15281 resolution to know this new IP.
15282
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015283When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015284HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015285SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15286from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015287will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015288will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015289
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015290A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015291 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015292 first valid response.
15293
15294 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15295 servers return an error.
15296
15297
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152985.3.2. The resolvers section
15299----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015300
15301This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015302HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15303contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015304
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015305When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15306uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15307is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15308answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15309
15310When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015311used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015312
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015313 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15314 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15315 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015316
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015317 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15318 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015319
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015320 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015321 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15322 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015323
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015324For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15325following scenarios are possible:
15326
15327 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15328 ignored
15329
15330 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15331 applied
15332
15333 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15334 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15335
15336 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15337 retries the query with a new type
15338
15339 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15340 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015341
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015342As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015343a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015344<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015345
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015346
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015347resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015348 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015349
15350A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15351
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015352accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015353 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015354 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015355 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15356 by RFC 6891)
15357
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015358 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15359 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15360 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15361 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15362 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15363 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015364
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015365nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15366 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15367 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15368 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15369 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15370 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15371 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15372 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15373 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15374 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015375 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15376
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015377parse-resolv-conf
15378 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15379 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15380 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15381
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015382hold <status> <period>
Christopher Fauletcd978582023-02-27 17:53:31 +010015383 Upon receiving the DNS response <status>, determines whether a server's state
15384 should change from UP to DOWN. To make that determination, it checks whether
15385 any valid status has been received during the past <period> in order to
15386 counteract the just received invalid status.
15387
15388 <status> : last name resolution status.
15389 nx After receiving an NXDOMAIN status, check for any valid
15390 status during the concluding period.
15391
15392 refused After receiving a REFUSED status, check for any valid
15393 status during the concluding period.
15394
15395 timeout After the "timeout retry" has struck, check for any
15396 valid status during the concluding period.
15397
15398 other After receiving any other invalid status, check for any
15399 valid status during the concluding period.
15400
15401 valid Applies only to "http-request do-resolve" and
15402 "tcp-request content do-resolve" actions. It defines the
15403 period for which the server will maintain a valid response
15404 before triggering another resolution. It does not affect
15405 dynamic resolution of servers.
15406
15407 obsolete Defines how long to wait before removing obsolete DNS
15408 records after an updated answer record is received. It
15409 applies to SRV records.
15410
15411 <period> : Amount of time into the past during which a valid response must
15412 have been received. It follows the HAProxy time format and is in
15413 milliseconds by default.
15414
15415 For a server that relies on dynamic DNS resolution to determine its IP
15416 address, receiving an invalid DNS response, such as NXDOMAIN, will lead to
15417 changing the server's state from UP to DOWN. The hold directives define how
15418 far into the past to look for a valid response. If a valid response has been
15419 received within <period>, the just received invalid status will be ignored.
15420
15421 Unless a valid response has been receiving during the concluding period, the
15422 server will be marked as DOWN. For example, if "hold nx 30s" is set and the
15423 last received DNS response was NXDOMAIN, the server will be marked DOWN
15424 unless a valid response has been received during the last 30 seconds.
15425
15426 A server in the DOWN state will be marked UP immediately upon receiving a
15427 valid status from the DNS server.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015428
Christopher Fauletcd978582023-02-27 17:53:31 +010015429 A separate behavior exists for "hold valid" and "hold obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015430
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015431resolve_retries <nb>
15432 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15433 giving up.
15434 Default value: 3
15435
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015436 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15437 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15438 type.
15439
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015440timeout <event> <time>
15441 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15442 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15443 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015444 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15445 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015446 Default value: 1s
15447 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015448 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015449 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015450 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15451 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15452
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015453 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015454
15455 resolvers mydns
15456 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15457 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015458 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015459 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015460 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015461 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015462 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015463 hold other 30s
15464 hold refused 30s
15465 hold nx 30s
15466 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015467 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015468 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015469
15470
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200154716. Cache
15472---------
15473
15474HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15475(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15476RAM.
15477
15478The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15479this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15480
15481If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15482independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15483when we try to allocate a new one.
15484
15485The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15486
15487It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15488"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15489for more details.
15490
15491When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15492replaced by "<CACHE>".
15493
15494
154956.1. Limitation
15496----------------
15497
15498The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15499
15500- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015501- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15502 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15503 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015504- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15505- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015506- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15507 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15508 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015509- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15510 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015511- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15512 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15513 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015514
15515- If the request is not a GET
15516- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15517- If the request contains an Authorization header
15518
15519
155206.2. Setup
15521-----------
15522
15523To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15524the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15525
15526
155276.2.1. Cache section
15528---------------------
15529
15530cache <name>
15531 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15532 size of cache is mandatory.
15533
15534total-max-size <megabytes>
15535 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15536 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15537
15538max-object-size <bytes>
15539 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15540 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15541 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15542
15543max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015544 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015545 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15546 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15547 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15548 default.
15549
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015550process-vary <on/off>
15551 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015552 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15553 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15554 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015555 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015556
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015557max-secondary-entries <number>
15558 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15559 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15560 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15561
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015562
155636.2.2. Proxy section
15564---------------------
15565
15566http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15567 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15568 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15569 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15570 after this one.
15571
15572http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15573 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15574 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15575 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15576 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15577
15578
15579Example:
15580
15581 backend bck1
15582 mode http
15583
15584 http-request cache-use foobar
15585 http-response cache-store foobar
15586 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15587
15588 cache foobar
15589 total-max-size 4
15590 max-age 240
15591
15592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155937. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15594----------------------------------
15595
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015596HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015597client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15598The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15599these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15600but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15601data called patterns.
15602
15603
156047.1. ACL basics
15605---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015606
15607The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15608content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15609from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15610simple :
15611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015612 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015613 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015614 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15615 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015617The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15618adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015619
15620In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015622 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015623
15624This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15625Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15626and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015627an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15628conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15629as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15630are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015631
15632ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15633'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15634which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15635
15636There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15637performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015639The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15640specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15641this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015642methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15643ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015644
15645Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15646 - boolean
15647 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15648 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15649 - string
15650 - data block
15651
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015652Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15653converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15654would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15655The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15656which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15657
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015658Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15659keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15660fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15661which are summarized in the table below :
15662
15663 +---------------------+-----------------+
15664 | Sample or converter | Default |
15665 | output type | matching method |
15666 +---------------------+-----------------+
15667 | boolean | bool |
15668 +---------------------+-----------------+
15669 | integer | int |
15670 +---------------------+-----------------+
15671 | ip | ip |
15672 +---------------------+-----------------+
15673 | string | str |
15674 +---------------------+-----------------+
15675 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15676 +---------------------+-----------------+
15677
15678Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15679matching method, see below.
15680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015681The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15682 - boolean
15683 - integer or integer range
15684 - IP address / network
15685 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15686 - regular expression
15687 - hex block
15688
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015689The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15690
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015691 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15692 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015694 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015695 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015696 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015697 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15700read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15701if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15702lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15703will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15704beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015705a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015706lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15707exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15708
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015709The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15710parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15711ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15712a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15713check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15714
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015715The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15716socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15717file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15720loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15721
15722 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15723
15724In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15725the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15726case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15727as well.
15728
15729The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15730sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15731do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15732methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15733is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015734obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015735followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15736default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15737that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15738string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15739
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015740The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15741By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15742string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15743resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015744server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015745waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015746flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15747function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015749There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15750sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15751be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015752
15753 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15754 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015755 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15756 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15757 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15758 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015759
15760 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15761 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015763
15764 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015765 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015766
15767 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015768 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015770 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015771 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15772
15773 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15774 binary or string samples.
15775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015776 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15777 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015779 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15780 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15781 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015783 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15784 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015786 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15787 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015789 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15790 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015792 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15793 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015794 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015796 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15797 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15798 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015799
15800For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15801request, it is possible to do :
15802
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015803 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015804
15805In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15806buffer, one would use the following acl :
15807
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015808 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015809
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015810On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15811possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15812
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015813 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015815All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15816criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15817method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreauedbeab12022-11-25 10:49:41 +010015818to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
15819usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
15820converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
15821method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
15822matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015823criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15824the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015826If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015827the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15828For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015830 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15831 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15832 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15833 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015834
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015835
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015836The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15837types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15838combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15839brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15840default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015842 +-------------------------------------------------+
15843 | Input sample type |
15844 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015845 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015846 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15847 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15848 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015849 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015850 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015851 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015852 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015853 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015854 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015855 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015856 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015857 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015858 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015859 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015860 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015861 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015862 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015863 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015864 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015865 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015866 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015867 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015868 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015869 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015870 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15871 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15872 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015873
15874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158757.1.1. Matching booleans
15876------------------------
15877
15878In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15879Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15880When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15881that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15882
15883Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15884return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15885"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15886
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158887.1.2. Matching integers
15889------------------------
15890
15891Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15892enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15893to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15894
15895Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15896matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15897lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015898
15899For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15900unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15901representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15902
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015903As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15904two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15905instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15906ranges and operators.
15907
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015908For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015909operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15910Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15911of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015912
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015913Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015914
15915 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15916 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15917 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15918 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15919 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15920
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015921For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015922
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015923 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015924
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015925This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15926
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015927 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015928
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159307.1.3. Matching strings
15931-----------------------
15932
15933String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15934different forms :
15935
15936 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015937 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938
15939 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015940 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015941
15942 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15943 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15944
15945 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15946 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15947
Willy Tarreau71e58732022-11-25 12:02:25 +010015948 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
15949 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
15950 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
15951 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
15952 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
15953 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015954
Willy Tarreau71e58732022-11-25 12:02:25 +010015955 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
15956 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
15957 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
15958 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
15959 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
15960 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
15961 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
15962 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
15963 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
15964 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
15965 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015966
15967String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15968exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15969characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15970string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15971to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015972before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015973
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015974Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15975(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15976Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15977
15978Example:
15979 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15980 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15981
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159837.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15984---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015985
15986Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15987they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15988possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15989passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15990the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015991the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15992match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015993
15994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159957.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15996-------------------------------------
15997
15998It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15999not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
16000a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
16001to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
16002digits may be used upper or lower case.
16003
16004Example :
16005 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016006 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007
16008
160097.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
16010---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016011
16012IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
16013netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
16014within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010016015host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016016difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
16017at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
16018does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
16019parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016020
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020016021The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
16022abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
16023
16024 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16025 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
16026 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16027 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
16028 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
16029 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
16030 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
16031 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16032
16033Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
16034192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
16035
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020016036IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
16037Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
16038trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
16039IPv6 patterns.
16040
16041HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
16042following situations :
16043 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
16044 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16045 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16046 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16047 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16048 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16049 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16050 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16051 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16052 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054
160557.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16056----------------------------------
16057
16058Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16059combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16060
16061 - AND (implicit)
16062 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16063 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016065A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016067 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016069Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16070indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016072For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16073"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16074requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16075is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16076
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016077 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016078 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16079 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16080 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016081
16082To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16083and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16084
16085 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16086 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16087 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16088 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16089
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016090 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016091 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16092 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16093 use_backend www if host_www
16094
16095It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16096expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16097be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16098the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16099
16100 The following rule :
16101
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016102 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016103 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016104
16105 Can also be written that way :
16106
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016107 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016108
16109It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16110to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16111simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16112sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16113good use is the following :
16114
16115 With named ACLs :
16116
16117 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16118 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16119 monitor fail if site_dead
16120
16121 With anonymous ACLs :
16122
16123 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16124
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016125See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16126keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016127
16128
161297.3. Fetching samples
16130---------------------
16131
16132Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16133against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16134sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16135ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16136of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16137available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16138
16139This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16140Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16141compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16142deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16143
16144The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16145matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16146method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16147indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16148
16149As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16150when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16151mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16152the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16153ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16154
16155Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16156multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16157when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016158incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16159are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016160is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16161all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16162
16163Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16164 - name
16165 - name(arg1)
16166 - name(arg1,arg2)
16167
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016168
161697.3.1. Converters
16170-----------------
16171
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016172Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16173of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16174is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16175was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016176has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016177unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16178
16179These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16180sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16181the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016182support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016183
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016184A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16185support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16186supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16187(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16188bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016190The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016191
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001619251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16193 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16194 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16195 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16196 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16197 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16198
16199 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016200 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16201 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016202 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16203 frontend http-in
16204 bind *:8081
16205 default_backend servers
16206 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16207 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16208
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016209add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016210 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016211 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016212 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16213 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016214 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016215 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16216 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16217 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16218 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016219 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016220 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016221
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016222aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16223 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16224 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16225 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16226 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16227 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16228 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16229
16230 Example:
16231 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16232 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16233
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016234and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016235 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016236 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016237 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16238 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016239 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016240 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16241 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16242 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16243 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016244 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016245 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016246
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016247b64dec
16248 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16249 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016250 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16251 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016252
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016253base64
16254 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016255 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016256 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16257 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016258
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016259bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016260 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016261 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016262 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016263 presence of a flag).
16264
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016265bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16266 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16267 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016268 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016269
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016270concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16271 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16272 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16273 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16274 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16275 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16276 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16277 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16278 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16279 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16280 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016281 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016282 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016283 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16284 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016285
16286 Example:
16287 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16288 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16289 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016290 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016291 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16292
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016293cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016294 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16295 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016296
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016297crc32([<avalanche>])
16298 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16299 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16300 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16301 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16302 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16303 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16304 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16305 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16306 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16307 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016308 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16309
16310crc32c([<avalanche>])
16311 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16312 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16313 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16314 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16315 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16316 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16317 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16318 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016319
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016320cut_crlf
16321 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16322 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16323 updated.
16324
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016325da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016326 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16327 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16328 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16329 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016330 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016331 configuration language.
16332
16333 Example:
16334 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016335 bind *:8881
16336 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016337 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016338
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016339debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16340 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16341 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16342 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16343 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16344 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16345 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16346 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16347 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16348 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16349 printable sample types.
16350
16351 Example:
16352 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016353
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016354digest(<algorithm>)
16355 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16356 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16357
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016358 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016359 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16360
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016361div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016362 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16363 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016364 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016365 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16366 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016367 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016368 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16369 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16370 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16371 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016372 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016373 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016374
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016375djb2([<avalanche>])
16376 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16377 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16378 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16379 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16380 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16381 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16382 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016383 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16384 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016385
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016386even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016387 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016388 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16389
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016390field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16391 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16392 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16393 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16394 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16395 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16396 fields.
16397
16398 Example :
Tim Duesterhus1d8c2e62023-11-30 16:41:18 +010016399 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(4,_) # <empty>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016400 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16401 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16402 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16403 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16404 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016405
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016406fix_is_valid
16407 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16408 Information eXchange):
16409
16410 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16411 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016412 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016413 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016414 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016415 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16416 checksum
16417
16418 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16419 the server can be parsed.
16420
16421 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16422 message, false if not.
16423
16424 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16425
16426 Example:
16427 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16428 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16429
16430fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16431 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16432 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16433 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16434 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016435 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016436 added.
16437
16438 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16439 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16440 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16441 fix_is_valid converter.
16442
16443 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16444
16445 Example:
16446 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16447 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16448 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16449 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16450 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16451
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016452hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016453 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016454 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016455 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016456 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016457
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016458hex2i
16459 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016460 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016461
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016462htonl
16463 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16464 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16465 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16466 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16467
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016468hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016469 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16470 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16471 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16472 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16473
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016474 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016475 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16476
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016477http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016478 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16479 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016480 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16481 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16482 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16483 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16484 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16485 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16486 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16487 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016488
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016489iif(<true>,<false>)
16490 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16491 string otherwise.
16492
16493 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016494 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016495
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016496in_table(<table>)
16497 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16498 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16499 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016500 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016501 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16502
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016503ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016504 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016505 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016506 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16507 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16508 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16509 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16510 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016511
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016512json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016513 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016514 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016515 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016516 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16517 of errors:
16518 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16519 bytes, ...)
16520 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16521 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16522
16523 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16524 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16525 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16526 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16527 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16528 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016529 - "ascii" : never fails;
16530 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16531 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016532 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016533 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016534 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16535 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16536
16537 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016538 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016539
16540 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016541 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016542 capture request header user-agent len 150
16543 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016544
16545 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16546 GET / HTTP/1.0
16547 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16548
16549 Output log:
16550 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16551
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016552json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16553 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16554 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16555 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16556 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16557
16558 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16559 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16560
16561 Example:
16562 # get a integer value from the request body
16563 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16564 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16565
16566 # get a key with '.' in the name
16567 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16568 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16569
16570 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16571 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16572
16573 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16574 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16575
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016576language(<value>[,<default>])
16577 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16578 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16579 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16580 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16581 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16582 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16583 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16584 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16585 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016586 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016587 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16588 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016589
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016590 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016591
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016592 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16593 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016594
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016595 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16596 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16597 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16598 use_backend spanish if es
16599 use_backend french if fr
16600 use_backend english if en
16601 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016602
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016603length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016604 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16605 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16606 type. The result is of type integer.
16607
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016608lower
16609 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16610 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16611 type. The result is of type string.
16612
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016613ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16614 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16615 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16616 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16617 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16618 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16619 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16620
16621 Example :
16622
16623 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016624 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016625 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16626
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016627ltrim(<chars>)
16628 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16629 representation of the input sample.
16630
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016631map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16632map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16633map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16634 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16635 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16636 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16637 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16638 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16639 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16640 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16641 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016642
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016643 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16644 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16645 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016646
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016647 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016648 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016649
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016650 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16651 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16652 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16653 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016654 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16655 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016656 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16657 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16658 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16659 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16660 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16661 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16662 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16663 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016664 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16665 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16666 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016667 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16668 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16669 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16670 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16671 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016672
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016673 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16674 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16675 the corresponding match text.
16676
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016677 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16678 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16679 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16680 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16681 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016682
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016683 Example :
16684
16685 # this is a comment and is ignored
16686 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16687 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16688 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16689 | | | `---------- value
16690 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16691 | `---------------------------- key
16692 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16693
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016694mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016695 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16696 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016697 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016698 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016699 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016700 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16701 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16702 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16703 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016704 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016705 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016706
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016707mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016708 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16709 <packettype>.
16710 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16711 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16712 from.
16713 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16714 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16715 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16716
16717 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16718 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16719 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16720 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16721
16722 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16723 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16724 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16725 packets only):
16726 17: Session Expiry Interval
16727 33: Receive Maximum
16728 39: Maximum Packet Size
16729 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16730 25: Request Response Information
16731 23: Request Problem Information
16732 21: Authentication Method
16733 22: Authentication Data
16734 18: Will Delay Interval
16735 1: Payload Format Indicator
16736 2: Message Expiry Interval
16737 3: Content Type
16738 8: Response Topic
16739 9: Correlation Data
16740 Not supported yet:
16741 38: User Property
16742
16743 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16744 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16745 packets only):
16746 17: Session Expiry Interval
16747 33: Receive Maximum
16748 36: Maximum QoS
16749 37: Retain Available
16750 39: Maximum Packet Size
16751 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16752 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16753 31: Reason String
16754 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16755 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16756 42: Shared Subscription Available
16757 19: Server Keep Alive
16758 26: Response Information
16759 28: Server Reference
16760 21: Authentication Method
16761 22: Authentication Data
16762 Not supported yet:
16763 38: User Property
16764
16765 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16766 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16767 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16768 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16769
16770 Example:
16771
16772 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16773 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16774 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16775 if data_in_buffer
16776 # do the same as above
16777 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16778 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16779 if data_in_buffer
16780
16781mqtt_is_valid
16782 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16783
16784 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16785 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16786 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16787 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16788
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016789 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16790
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016791 Example:
16792
16793 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016794 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016795
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016796mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016797 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016798 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16799 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016800 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016801 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016802 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016803 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16804 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16805 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16806 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016807 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016808 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016809
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016810nbsrv
16811 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16812 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16813 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16814 map lookup.
16815
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016816neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016817 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16818 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16819 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16820 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016821
16822not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016823 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016824 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016825 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016826 absence of a flag).
16827
16828odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016829 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016830 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16831
16832or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016833 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016834 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016835 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16836 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016837 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016838 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16839 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16840 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16841 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016842 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016843 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016844
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016845protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16846 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16847 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16848 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16849 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16850 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16851 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16852 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16853 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16854 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16855 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16856 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16857
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016858regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016859 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16860 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16861 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16862 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16863 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16864 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16865 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16866 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16867 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016868 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16869 of characters with other ones.
16870
16871 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16872 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16873 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16874 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16875 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16876 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016877
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016878 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016879
16880 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16881 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16882 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016883 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016884
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016885 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16886 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16887
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016888 # capture groups and backreferences
16889 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016890 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016891 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16892
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016893capture-req(<id>)
16894 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16895 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16896
16897 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016898 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16899 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016900
16901capture-res(<id>)
16902 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16903 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16904
16905 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016906 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16907 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016908
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016909rtrim(<chars>)
16910 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16911 of the input sample.
16912
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016913sdbm([<avalanche>])
16914 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16915 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16916 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16917 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16918 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16919 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16920 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016921 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16922 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016923
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016924secure_memcmp(<var>)
16925 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16926 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16927 match.
16928
16929 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16930 performed in constant time.
16931
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016932 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016933 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16934
16935 Example :
16936
16937 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16938 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16939 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16940 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16941
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016942set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016943 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16944 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16945 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016946 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016947 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16948 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016949 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016950 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16951 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016952 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016953 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016954
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016955sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016956 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016957 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16958
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016959sha2([<bits>])
16960 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16961 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16962
16963 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16964 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16965
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016966 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016967 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16968
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016969srv_queue
16970 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16971 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16972 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16973 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16974 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16975
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016976strcmp(<var>)
16977 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16978 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16979 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16980 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16981 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16982 shorter).
16983
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016984 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16985 strings in constant time.
16986
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016987 Example :
16988
16989 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16990 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16991 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16992
16993
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016994sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016995 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16996 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016997 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016998 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16999 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017000 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017001 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17002 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017003 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017004 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17005 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017006 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017007 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017008
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017009table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
17010 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17011 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17012 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
17013 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17014 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17015 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
17016
17017
17018table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
17019 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17020 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17021 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
17022 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17023 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17024 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
17025
17026table_conn_cnt(<table>)
17027 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17028 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017029 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017030 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
17031 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17032
17033table_conn_cur(<table>)
17034 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17035 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17036 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17037 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17038 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
17039
17040table_conn_rate(<table>)
17041 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17042 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17043 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
17044 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17045 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
17046
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017047table_gpt0(<table>)
17048 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17049 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17050 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17051 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17052 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17053
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017054table_gpc0(<table>)
17055 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17056 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17057 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17058 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17059 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17060
17061table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17062 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17063 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17064 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17065 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17066 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17067 sample fetch keyword.
17068
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017069table_gpc1(<table>)
17070 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17071 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17072 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17073 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17074 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17075
17076table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17077 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17078 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17079 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17080 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17081 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17082 sample fetch keyword.
17083
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017084table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17085 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17086 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017087 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017088 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17089 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17090
17091table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17092 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17093 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17094 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17095 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17096 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17097 keyword.
17098
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017099table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17100 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17101 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17102 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17103 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17104 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17105
17106table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17107 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17108 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17109 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17110 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17111 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17112 keyword.
17113
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017114table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17115 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17116 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017117 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017118 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17119 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17120
17121table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17122 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17123 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17124 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17125 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17126 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17127 keyword.
17128
17129table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17130 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17131 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017132 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017133 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17134 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17135 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17136 keyword.
17137
17138table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17139 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17140 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017141 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017142 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17143 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17144 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17145 keyword.
17146
17147table_server_id(<table>)
17148 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17149 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17150 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17151 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17152 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17153 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17154
17155table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17156 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17157 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017158 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017159 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17160 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17161 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17162 keyword.
17163
17164table_sess_rate(<table>)
17165 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17166 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17167 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17168 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17169 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17170 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17171 keyword.
17172
17173table_trackers(<table>)
17174 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17175 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17176 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17177 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17178 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17179 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17180 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17181 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17182 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17183 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17184
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017185ub64dec
17186 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17187 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17188 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17189
17190 Example:
17191 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17192 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17193
17194ub64enc
17195 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17196
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017197upper
17198 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17199 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17200 type. The result is of type string.
17201
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017202url_dec([<in_form>])
17203 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17204 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17205 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17206 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17207 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17208 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017209
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017210url_enc([<enc_type>])
17211 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17212 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17213 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17214 optional argument is here for future changes.
17215
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017216ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017217 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017218 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17219 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17220 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017221 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17222 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17223 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17224 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017225 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017226 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17227 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017228
17229 Example:
17230 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17231 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17232
17233 message Point {
17234 int32 latitude = 1;
17235 int32 longitude = 2;
17236 }
17237
17238 message PPoint {
17239 Point point = 59;
17240 }
17241
17242 message Rectangle {
17243 // One corner of the rectangle.
17244 PPoint lo = 48;
17245 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17246 PPoint hi = 49;
17247 }
17248
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017249 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17250 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17251 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017252
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017253 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17254 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017255 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017256 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17257
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017258 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017259
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017260 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017261
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017262 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17263 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17264 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017265
17266 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17267 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17268 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17269
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017270 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17271 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17272 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017273
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017274
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017275unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017276 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17277 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17278 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17279 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17280 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17281 response),
17282 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17283 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17284 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17285 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17286
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017287utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17288 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17289 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17290 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17291 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17292 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17293 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17294
17295 Example :
17296
17297 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017298 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017299 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17300
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017301word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17302 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17303 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17304 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Tim Duesterhus1d8c2e62023-11-30 16:41:18 +010017305 Empty words are skipped. This means that delimiters at the start or end of
17306 the input string are ignored and consecutive delimiters within the input
17307 string are considered to be a single delimiter.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017308 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17309 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17310
17311 Example :
17312 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
Tim Duesterhus1d8c2e62023-11-30 16:41:18 +010017313 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(5,_) # <not found>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017314 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17315 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17316 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17317 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017318 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Tim Duesterhus1d8c2e62023-11-30 16:41:18 +010017319 str(/f1////f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017320
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017321wt6([<avalanche>])
17322 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17323 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17324 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17325 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17326 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17327 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17328 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017329 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17330 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017331
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017332xor(<value>)
17333 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017334 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017335 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017336 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017337 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017338 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17339 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017340 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017341 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17342 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017343 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017344 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017345
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017346xxh3([<seed>])
17347 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17348 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17349 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17350 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17351 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17352 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17353 considered as cryptographically secure.
17354
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017355xxh32([<seed>])
17356 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17357 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17358 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17359 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17360 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17361 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17362 as cryptographically secure.
17363
17364xxh64([<seed>])
17365 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17366 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17367 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17368 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17369 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17370 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17371 as cryptographically secure.
17372
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017373
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173747.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017375--------------------------------------------
17376
17377A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17378not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17379"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17380The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17381
17382always_false : boolean
17383 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17384 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17385
17386always_true : boolean
17387 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17388 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17389
17390avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017391 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017392 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17393 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17394 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17395 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17396 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17397 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17398 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17399 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17400 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17401 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17402 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17403 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17404 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017406be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017407 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17408 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17409 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17410 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017411 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17412
17413be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17414 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17415 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17416 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17417 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17418 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017419 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17420 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017421
17422 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17423 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17424 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017426be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17427 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17428 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17429 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017430 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017431 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17432 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017433
17434 Example :
17435 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17436 backend dynamic
17437 mode http
17438 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17439 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017440
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017441bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017442 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17443 of the string.
17444
17445bool(<bool>) : bool
17446 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17447 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017449connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17450 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017451 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017452 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17453 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017454
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017455 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017456 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017457 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17458
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017459 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17460 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017461
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017462 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017463 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017464 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017465 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017466 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017467 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017468 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017469
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017470 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17471 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017472 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017473 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017474
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017475cpu_calls : integer
17476 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17477 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17478 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17479 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17480 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17481 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17482
17483cpu_ns_avg : integer
17484 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17485 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17486 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17487 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17488 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17489 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17490 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17491 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17492 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17493 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17494 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17495
17496cpu_ns_tot : integer
17497 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17498 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17499 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17500 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17501 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17502 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17503 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17504 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17505 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17506 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17507 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17508 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17509 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17510
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017511date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017512 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017513
17514 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17515 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17516 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017517 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17518
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017519 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17520 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17521 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17522 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17523 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17524
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017525 Example :
17526
17527 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17528 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017529
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017530 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17531 # millisecond granularity
17532 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17533
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017534date_us : integer
17535 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17536 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17537 from the same timeval structure.
17538
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017539distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17540 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17541 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17542 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17543 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017544 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017545 list of supported tokens.
17546
17547distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17548 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17549 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17550 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17551 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017552 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017553 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17554 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17555 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17556 supported tokens.
17557
17558 Example :
17559 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17560 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17561 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17562 # send large files to the big farm
17563 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17564
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017565env(<name>) : string
17566 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17567 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17568 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17569 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17570 certain way.
17571
17572 Examples :
17573 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17574 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17575
17576 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017577 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017579fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17580 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017581 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17582 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017583 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17584 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017585 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017586 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17587 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017588
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017589fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17590 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17591 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17592 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017594fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17595 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17596 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17597 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17598 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17599 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17600 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17601 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17602 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017603
17604 Example :
17605 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17606 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17607 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17608 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17609 frontend mail
17610 bind :25
17611 mode tcp
17612 maxconn 100
17613 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17614 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17615 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17616 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017617
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017618hostname : string
17619 Returns the system hostname.
17620
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017621int(<integer>) : signed integer
17622 Returns a signed integer.
17623
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017624ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17625 Returns an ipv4.
17626
17627ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17628 Returns an ipv6.
17629
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017630lat_ns_avg : integer
17631 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17632 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17633 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17634 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17635 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17636 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17637 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17638 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17639 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017640 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17641 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17642 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17643 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17644 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17645 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017646
17647lat_ns_tot : integer
17648 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17649 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17650 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17651 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17652 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17653 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17654 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17655 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17656 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017657 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17658 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17659 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17660 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17661 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017662 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17663 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17664 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17665 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17666 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17667 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17668
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017669meth(<method>) : method
17670 Returns a method.
17671
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017672nbproc : integer
17673 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17674 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17675 and debugging purposes.
17676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017677nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17678 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17679 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17680 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017681 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17682 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17683 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017684
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017685prio_class : integer
17686 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17687 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17688 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17689
17690prio_offset : integer
17691 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17692 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17693 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17694 set-priority-offset".
17695
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017696proc : integer
17697 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17698 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17699 debugging purposes.
17700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017701queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017702 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17703 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17704 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017705 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17706 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17707 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17708 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17709 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17710
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017711rand([<range>]) : integer
17712 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17713 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17714 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17715 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17716 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017718srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17719 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17720 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17721 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17722 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17723 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017724 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17725 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17726
17727srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17728 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17729 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17730 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17731 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17732 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17733 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17734 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17735
17736 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17737 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017738
17739srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17740 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17741 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17742 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017743 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017744 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17745 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17746 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17747
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017748srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17749 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17750 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17751 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17752 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17753 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17754 fetch methods.
17755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017756srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17757 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17758 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017759 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017760 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17761 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017762 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017763 overloading servers).
17764
17765 Example :
17766 # Redirect to a separate back
17767 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17768 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17769 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17770
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017771srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017772 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17773 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17774 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17775
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017776srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017777 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17778 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17779 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17780
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017781srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017782 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17783 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17784 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17785
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017786stopping : boolean
17787 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17788 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17789 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17790
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017791str(<string>) : string
17792 Returns a string.
17793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017794table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17795 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17796 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17797
17798table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17799 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17800 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17801 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17802
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017803thread : integer
17804 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17805 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17806 and debugging purposes.
17807
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017808uuid([<version>]) : string
17809 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17810 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17811 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17812
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017813var(<var-name>) : undefined
17814 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017815 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17816 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017817 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017818 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17819 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017820 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017821 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17822 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017823 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017824 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017825
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200178267.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017827----------------------------------
17828
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017829The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017830closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17831methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17832sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17833TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017834the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17835counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017836"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17837used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17838can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17839Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17840table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17841tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17842currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017843
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017844bc_dst : ip
17845 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17846 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17847 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17848 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17849
17850bc_dst_port : integer
17851 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017852 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017853
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017854bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017855 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17856 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17857 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17858
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017859bc_src : ip
17860 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017861 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017862 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17863 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17864
17865bc_src_port : integer
17866 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017867 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017869be_id : integer
17870 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017871 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17872 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017873
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017874be_name : string
17875 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017876 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17877 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017878
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017879be_server_timeout : integer
17880 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17881 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17882 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17883
17884be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17885 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17886 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17887 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17888
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017889cur_server_timeout : integer
17890 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17891 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17892 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17893
17894cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17895 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17896 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17897 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017899dst : ip
17900 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17901 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17902 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17903 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017904 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17905 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17906 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17907 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17908 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17909 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017910
17911dst_conn : integer
17912 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17913 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17914 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17915 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17916 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17917 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17918 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17919 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017920
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017921dst_is_local : boolean
17922 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17923 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17924 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17925 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017926 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017927 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17928 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17929 it only once per connection.
17930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017931dst_port : integer
17932 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17933 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17934 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17935 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17936 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17937 an HTTP header.
17938
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017939fc_fackets : integer
17940 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17941 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17942 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17943 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17944
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017945fc_http_major : integer
17946 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17947 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17948 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17949
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017950fc_lost : integer
17951 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17952 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17953 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17954 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17955
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017956fc_pp_authority : string
17957 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17958 if any.
17959
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017960fc_pp_unique_id : string
17961 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17962 if any.
17963
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017964fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17965 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17966 header.
17967
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017968fc_reordering : integer
17969 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17970 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17971 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17972 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17973
17974fc_retrans : integer
17975 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17976 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17977 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17978 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17979
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017980fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17981 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17982 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17983 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17984 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17985 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17986 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17987
17988fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17989 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17990 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17991 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17992 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17993 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17994 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17995
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017996fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017997 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17998 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17999 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18000 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18001
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018002
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018003fc_unacked : integer
18004 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18005 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18006 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18007 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018008
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020018009fe_defbe : string
18010 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
18011 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
18012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018013fe_id : integer
18014 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010018015 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018016 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18017
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018018fe_name : string
18019 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
18020 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
18021 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18022
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010018023fe_client_timeout : integer
18024 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
18025 current frontend.
18026
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018027sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018028sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18029sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18030sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018031 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
18032 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18033 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
18034
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018035sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018036sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18037sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18038sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018039 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
18040 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18041 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18042
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018043sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018044sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18045sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18046sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018047 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18048 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018049 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18050 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18051 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018052
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018053 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018054 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18055 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018056 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18057 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18058 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018059 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18060 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18061
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018062sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18063sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18064sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18065sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18066 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18067 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18068 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18069 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18070 when a first ACL was verified.
18071
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018072sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018073sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18074sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18075sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018076 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018077 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18078
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018079sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018080sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18081sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18082sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018083 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18084 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18085 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18086
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018087sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018088sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18089sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18090sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018091 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18092 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18093 See also src_conn_rate.
18094
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018095sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018096sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18097sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18098sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018099 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018100 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018101
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018102sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18103sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18104sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18105sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18106 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18107 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18108
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018109sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18110sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18111sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18112sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18113 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18114 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18115
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018116sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018117sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18118sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18119sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018120 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18121 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18122 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018123 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18124 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18125 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018126
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018127sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18128sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18129sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18130sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18131 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18132 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18133 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18134 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18135 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18136 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18137
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018138sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018139sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18140sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18141sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018142 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018143 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18144 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18145
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018146sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018147sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18148sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18149sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018150 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18151 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18152 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18153 src_http_err_rate.
18154
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018155sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18156sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18157sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18158sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18159 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18160 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18161 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18162
18163sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18164sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18165sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18166sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18167 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18168 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18169 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18170 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18171
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018172sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018173sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18174sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18175sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018176 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018177 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18178 src_http_req_cnt.
18179
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018180sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018181sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18182sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18183sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018184 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18185 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18186 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18187 src_http_req_rate.
18188
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018189sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018190sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18191sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18192sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018193 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018194 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18195 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18196 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18197 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018198
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018199 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018200 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18201 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018202 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18203
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018204sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18205sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18206sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18207sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18208 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18209 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18210 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18211 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18212 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18213
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018214sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018215sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18216sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18217sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018218 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18219 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18220 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018221
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018222sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018223sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18224sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18225sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018226 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18227 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18228 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018229
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018230sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018231sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18232sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18233sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018234 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018235 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18236 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18237 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018238 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018239 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18240
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018241sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018242sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18243sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18244sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018245 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18246 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18247 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18248 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18249 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018250 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018251
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018252sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018253sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18254sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18255sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018256 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18257 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18258 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18259
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018260sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018261sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18262sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18263sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018264 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18265 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018266 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018267 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18268 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018269 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18270 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18271 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018273so_id : integer
18274 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18275 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18276 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018277
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018278so_name : string
18279 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18280 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18281 strings instead of integers.
18282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018283src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018284 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018285 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18286 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18287 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018288 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18289 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18290 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018291 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18292 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18293 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18294 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18295 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18296 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18297 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018298
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018299 Example:
18300 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18301 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018303src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18304 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18305 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18306 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018307 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018309src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18310 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18311 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018312 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018313 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018315src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18316 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18317 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18318 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18319 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18320 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18321 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018322
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018323 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018324 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18325 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18326 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18327 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018328 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018329 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18330 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18331
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018332src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18333 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18334 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18335 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18336 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18337 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18338 was verified.
18339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018340src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018341 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018342 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018343 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018344 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018346src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018347 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018348 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18349 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018350 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018352src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18353 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18354 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18355 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018356 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018358src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018359 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018360 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018361 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018362 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018363
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018364src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18365 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18366 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18367 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18368 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18369
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018370src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18371 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18372 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18373 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18374 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018376src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018377 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018378 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018379 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18380 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018381 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18382 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18383 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018384
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018385src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18386 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18387 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18388 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18389 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18390 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18391 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18392 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018394src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018395 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018396 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018397 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018398 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018399 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018401src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18402 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18403 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18404 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18405 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018406 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018407
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018408src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18409 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18410 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018411 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018412 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18413 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18414
18415src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18416 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18417 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18418 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18419 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18420 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18421 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018423src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018424 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018425 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18426 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018427 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018429src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18430 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18431 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18432 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018433 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018434 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018436src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18437 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18438 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18439 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018440 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018441 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18442 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018443
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018444 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018445 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018446 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018447 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018448
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018449src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18450 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18451 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18452 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18453 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18454 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18455 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18456
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018457src_is_local : boolean
18458 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18459 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18460 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18461 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018462 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018463 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18464 once per connection.
18465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018466src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018467 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18468 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18469 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18470 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18471 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018473src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018474 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18475 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18476 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18477 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18478 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018480src_port : integer
18481 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18482 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18483 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18484 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018486src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018487 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018488 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18489 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18490 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018491 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018493src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18494 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18495 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18496 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18497 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018498 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018500src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18501 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18502 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18503 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18504 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18505 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18506 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18507 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18508 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018509
18510 Example :
18511 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18512 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18513 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18514 listen ssh
18515 bind :22
18516 mode tcp
18517 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018518 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018519 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018520 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018522srv_id : integer
18523 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18524 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018525 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018526
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018527srv_name : string
18528 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18529 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018530 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018531
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200185327.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018533----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018534
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018535The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018536closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18537when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18538usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018539future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018540
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001854151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18542 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18543 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18544 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18545 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18546 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18547
18548 Example :
18549 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18550 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18551 # the request.
18552 frontend http-in
18553 bind *:8081
18554 default_backend servers
18555 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18556 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18557
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018558ssl_bc : boolean
18559 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18560 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Mariam John3d379952023-05-22 13:11:13 -050018561 to a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018562 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018563
18564ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18565 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018566 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18567 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018568
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018569ssl_bc_alpn : string
18570 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18571 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018572 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018573 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18574 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18575 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18576 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18577 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018578 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18579 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018580
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018581ssl_bc_cipher : string
18582 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018583 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18584 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018585
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018586ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18587 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18588 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18589 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018590 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018591
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018592ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18593 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18594 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018595 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18596 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018597
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018598ssl_bc_npn : string
18599 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18600 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018601 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018602 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18603 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18604 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18605 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018606 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18607 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018608
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018609ssl_bc_protocol : string
18610 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018611 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18612 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018613
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018614ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018615 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018616 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018617 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18618 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018619
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018620ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18621 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18622 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18623 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018624 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018625
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018626ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18627 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18628 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018629 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18630 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018631
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018632ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18633 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18634 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18635 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018636 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018637
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018638ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18639 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018640 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18641 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018643ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18644 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18645 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18646 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18647 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18648 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018650ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18651 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18652 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18653 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18654 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018655
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018656ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018657 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18658 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18659 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018660 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018661 does not support resumed sessions.
18662
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018663ssl_c_der : binary
18664 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18665 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18666 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018668ssl_c_err : integer
18669 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18670 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18671 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18672 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18673 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018674
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018675ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018676 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18677 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18678 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18679 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18680 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18681 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18682 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18683 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018684 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18685 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18686 LDAP v3.
18687 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18688 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018690ssl_c_key_alg : string
18691 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18692 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18693 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018695ssl_c_notafter : string
18696 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18697 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18698 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018700ssl_c_notbefore : string
18701 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18702 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18703 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018704
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018705ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018706 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18707 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18708 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18709 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18710 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18711 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18712 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18713 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018714 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18715 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18716 LDAP v3.
18717 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18718 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018720ssl_c_serial : binary
18721 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18722 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18723 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018725ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18726 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18727 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18728 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018729 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18730 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18731
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018732 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018733 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018735ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18736 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18737 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18738 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018740ssl_c_used : boolean
18741 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18742 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018744ssl_c_verify : integer
18745 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18746 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18747 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18748 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018750ssl_c_version : integer
18751 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18752 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018753
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018754ssl_f_der : binary
18755 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18756 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18757 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18758
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018759ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018760 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18761 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18762 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18763 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018764 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018765 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18766 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18767 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018768 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18769 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18770 LDAP v3.
18771 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18772 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018774ssl_f_key_alg : string
18775 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18776 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18777 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018779ssl_f_notafter : string
18780 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18781 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18782 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018784ssl_f_notbefore : string
18785 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18786 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18787 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018788
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018789ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018790 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18791 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18792 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18793 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18794 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18795 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18796 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18797 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018798 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18799 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18800 LDAP v3.
18801 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18802 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018804ssl_f_serial : binary
18805 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18806 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18807 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018808
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018809ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18810 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18811 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18812 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018814ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18815 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18816 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18817 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018819ssl_f_version : integer
18820 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18821 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18822
18823ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018824 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18825 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18826 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018828 Example :
18829 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18830 listen http-https
18831 bind :80
18832 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18833 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18834
18835ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18836 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18837 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18838
18839ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018840 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018841 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018842 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018843 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18844 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18845 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18846 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18847 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18848 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018850ssl_fc_cipher : string
18851 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18852 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018853
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018854ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18855 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18856 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018857 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018858
18859ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18860 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18861 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018862 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018863
18864ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18865 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18866 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18867 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018868 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018869 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018870
18871ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18872 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18873 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018874 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018875
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018876ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18877 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18878 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18879 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18880
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018881ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18882 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18883 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18884 transport layer.
18885 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18886 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18887 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18888 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18889
18890ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18891 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18892 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18893 transport layer.
18894 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18895 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18896 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18897 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18898
18899ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18900 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18901 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18902 transport layer.
18903 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18904 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18905 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18906 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18907
18908ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18909 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18910 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18911 transport layer.
18912 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18913 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18914 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18915 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18916
18917ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18918 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18919 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18920 transport layer.
18921 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18922 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18923 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18924 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018926ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018927 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18928 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018929 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18930 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18931 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18932 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018933
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018934ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18935 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18936 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18937 wait until the handshake happened.
18938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018939ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18940 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018941 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18942 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018943 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018944 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018945
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018946ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018947 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018948 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18949 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018951ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018952 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018953 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018954 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18955 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18956 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18957 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18958 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18959 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018961ssl_fc_protocol : string
18962 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18963 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018964
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018965ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018966 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018967 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018968 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018969
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018970ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18971 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18972 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18973 transport layer.
18974 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18975 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18976 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18977 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18978
18979ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18980 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18981 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18982 transport layer.
18983 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18984 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18985 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18986 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18987
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018988ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18989 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18990 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18991 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018993ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18994 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18995 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18996 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18997 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018998
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018999ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19000 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19001 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19002 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19003 BoringSSL.
19004
19005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019006ssl_fc_sni : string
19007 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19008 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019009 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019010 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19011 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19012
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019013 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019014 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019015 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019016 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019017 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019018
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010019019 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
19020 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
19021 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
19022 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
19023 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
19024 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
19025 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
19026 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
19027 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
19028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019029 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019030 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19031 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019033ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19034 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19035 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019036
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019037ssl_s_der : binary
19038 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19039 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19040 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19041
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019042ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19043 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19044 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19045 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019046 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019047 does not support resumed sessions.
19048
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019049ssl_s_key_alg : string
19050 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19051 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19052 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19053
19054ssl_s_notafter : string
19055 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19056 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19057 transport layer.
19058
19059ssl_s_notbefore : string
19060 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19061 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19062 transport layer.
19063
19064ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19065 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19066 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19067 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19068 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19069 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19070 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019071 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19072 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019073 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19074 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19075 LDAP v3.
19076 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19077 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19078
19079ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19080 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19081 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19082 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19083 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19084 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19085 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019086 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19087 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019088 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19089 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19090 LDAP v3.
19091 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19092 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19093
19094ssl_s_serial : binary
19095 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19096 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19097 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19098
19099ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19100 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19101 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19102 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19103
19104ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19105 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19106 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19107 layer.
19108
19109ssl_s_version : integer
19110 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19111 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019112
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200191137.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019114------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019116Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19117sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19118only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19119For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19120be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19121can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19122sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19123for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19124content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019125
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019126Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19127 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019128 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019129 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19130 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19131 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19132 sample expression). So be careful.
19133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019134payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019135 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019136 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19137 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019139payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19140 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019141 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019142 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019144req.len : integer
19145req_len : integer (deprecated)
19146 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19147 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19148 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19149 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19150 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019151 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019152 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19153 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019155req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19156 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019157 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19158 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19159 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19160 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019161
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019162 ACL derivatives :
19163 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019165req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19166 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19167 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19168 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19169 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019170
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019171 ACL derivatives :
19172 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019174 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019176req.proto_http : boolean
19177req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19178 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19179 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19180 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19181 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19182 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19183 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19184 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019186 Example:
19187 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19188 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19189 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019190 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019192req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19193rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19194 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19195 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19196 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19197 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19198 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19199 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19200 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019202 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19203 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19204 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19205 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19206 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19207 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019209 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019210 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019212 Example :
19213 listen tse-farm
19214 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19215 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19216 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19217 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19218 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19219 persist rdp-cookie
19220 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19221 # This is only useful makes sense if
19222 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19223 stick-table type string size 204800
19224 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19225 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19226 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019228 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019229 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019231req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19232rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19233 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19234 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19235 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19236 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019238 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019239 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019240
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019241req.ssl_alpn : string
19242 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19243 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19244 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19245 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19246 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19247 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019248 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019249
19250 Examples :
19251 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19252 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019253 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019254 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019255 default_backend bk_default
19256
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019257req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19258 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19259 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019260 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19261 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19262 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19263 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19264 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019266req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19267req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19268 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19269 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19270 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19271 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19272 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19273 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19274 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019276req.ssl_sni : string
19277req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19278 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19279 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19280 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19281 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19282 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019283 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19284 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19285 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19286 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19287 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19288 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19289 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19290 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19291 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019293 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019294 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019296 Examples :
19297 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19298 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019299 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019300 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019301 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019302
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019303req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19304 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19305 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19306 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19307 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19308 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19309 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19310 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19311 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19312 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019314req.ssl_ver : integer
19315req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19316 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19317 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19318 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19319 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19320 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19321 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19322 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019323 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019324 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019326 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019327 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019328
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019329res.len : integer
19330 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19331 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19332 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19333 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19334 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019335 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019336 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019337 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019339res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19340 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019341 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019342 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019343 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019344 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019346res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19347 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19348 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19349 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019350 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19351 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019353 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019354
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019355res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19356rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19357 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19358 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19359 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19360 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19361 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19362 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19363 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019365wait_end : boolean
19366 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19367 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019368 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019369 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19370 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019371 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019372 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19373 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019375 Examples :
19376 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19377 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19378 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019380 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19381 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19382 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19383 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19384 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19385 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19386 tcp-request content reject
19387
19388
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019390--------------------------------------
19391
19392It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19393This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19394data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19395its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19396HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19397content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19398to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19399more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19400response are indexed.
19401
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019402Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19403 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19404 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19405 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19406 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19407 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19408 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019410base : string
19411 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19412 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19413 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19414 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19415 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19416 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19417 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19418 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19419
19420 ACL derivatives :
19421 base : exact string match
19422 base_beg : prefix match
19423 base_dir : subdir match
19424 base_dom : domain match
19425 base_end : suffix match
19426 base_len : length match
19427 base_reg : regex match
19428 base_sub : substring match
19429
19430base32 : integer
19431 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19432 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19433 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019434 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19435 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19436 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019437
19438base32+src : binary
19439 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19440 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19441 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19442 per-URL counters.
19443
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019444baseq : string
19445 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19446 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19447 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19448 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19449
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019450capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19451 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19452 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19453 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19454
19455capture.req.method : string
19456 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19457 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19458 because it's allocated.
19459
19460capture.req.uri : string
19461 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19462 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19463 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19464 allocated.
19465
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019466capture.req.ver : string
19467 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19468 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19469 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19470
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019471capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19472 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19473 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19474 The first entry is an index of 0.
19475 See also: "capture response header"
19476
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019477capture.res.ver : string
19478 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19479 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19480 persistent flag.
19481
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019482req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019483 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19484 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19485 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019486
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019487req.body_param([<name>) : string
19488 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19489 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19490 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19491 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19492 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19493 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19494 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19495 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19496 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19497 given.
19498
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019499req.body_len : integer
19500 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19501 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019502 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19503 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019504
19505req.body_size : integer
19506 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019507 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19508 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019510req.cook([<name>]) : string
19511cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19512 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19513 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19514 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19515 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19516 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19517 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19518 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19519 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19520
19521 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019522 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19523 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19524 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19525 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19526 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19527 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19528 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19529 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019531req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19532cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19533 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19534 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019536req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19537cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19538 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19539 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19540 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19541 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019543cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19544 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19545 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19546 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19547 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019548 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019549 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19550 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19551 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19552 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019554hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19555 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19556 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19557 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19558 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019559 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019561req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019562 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19563 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19564 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19565 with headers such as User-Agent.
19566
19567 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19568 found.
19569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019570 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19571 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19572 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019573 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019575req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19576 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19577 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019578 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19579 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019581req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019582 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19583 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19584 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19585 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19586 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19587 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19588 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19589
19590 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19591 found.
19592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019593 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19594 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19595 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019596 with -1 being the last one.
19597
19598 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19599 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019601 ACL derivatives :
19602 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19603 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19604 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19605 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19606 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19607 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19608 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19609 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19610
19611req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19612hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19613 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19614 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019615 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19616 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19617 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19618
19619 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19620 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19621 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19622
19623 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019624
19625req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19626hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19627 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19628 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19629 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019630 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19631 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19632 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19633 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19634 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019635
19636 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19637
19638 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019639
19640req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19641hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19642 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19643 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19644 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019645
19646 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19647
19648 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019649
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019650req.hdrs : string
19651 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19652 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19653 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19654 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19655
19656req.hdrs_bin : binary
19657 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19658 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19659 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19660 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19661 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19662 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19663
19664 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019665
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019666 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19667 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019669http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19670 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19671 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19672 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19673 basic auth is supported.
19674
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019675http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19676 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19677 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19678 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19679 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019680 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19681 basic auth is supported.
19682
19683 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019684 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19685 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19686 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19687 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019688
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019689http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019690 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19691 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19692 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019693
19694http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019695 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19696 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19697 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019698
19699http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019700 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19701 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19702 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019704http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019705 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19706 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019707 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19708 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019710method : integer + string
19711 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19712 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19713 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19714 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19715 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19716 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19717 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019719 ACL derivatives :
19720 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019722 Example :
19723 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19724 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19725 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019727path : string
19728 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19729 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19730 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19731 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19732 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019733 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau3706e172023-08-08 19:35:25 +020019734 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods. Please
19735 note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#' after the path) is strictly
19736 forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be rejected. However, if the frontend
19737 receiving the request has "option accept-invalid-http-request", then this
19738 fragment part will be accepted and will also appear in the path.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019740 ACL derivatives :
19741 path : exact string match
19742 path_beg : prefix match
19743 path_dir : subdir match
19744 path_dom : domain match
19745 path_end : suffix match
19746 path_len : length match
19747 path_reg : regex match
19748 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019749
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019750pathq : string
19751 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19752 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19753 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19754 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19755 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
Willy Tarreau3706e172023-08-08 19:35:25 +020019756 result in both cases. Please note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#'
19757 after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
19758 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
19759 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
19760 will also appear in the path.
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019761
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019762query : string
19763 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19764 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19765 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19766 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019767 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019768 which stops before the question mark.
19769
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019770req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19771 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19772 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19773 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19774 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019776req.ver : string
19777req_ver : string (deprecated)
19778 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19779 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19780 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019782 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019783 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019784
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019785res.body : binary
19786 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19787 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019788 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19789
19790 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019791
19792res.body_len : integer
19793 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19794 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019795 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19796
19797 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019798
19799res.body_size : integer
19800 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19801 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19802 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19803 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019804 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19805
19806 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019807
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019808res.cache_hit : boolean
19809 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19810 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19811
19812res.cache_name : string
19813 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19814 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19815 empty string.
19816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019817res.comp : boolean
19818 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19819 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19820 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019822res.comp_algo : string
19823 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19824 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19825 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019827res.cook([<name>]) : string
19828scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19829 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19830 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019831 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19832
19833 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019835 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019836 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019838res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19839scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19840 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19841 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019842 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19843
19844 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019846res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19847scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19848 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19849 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019850 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19851
19852 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019854res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019855 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19856 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19857
19858 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19859 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19860
19861 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19862
19863 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019865res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019866 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19867 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19868
19869 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19870 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19871
19872 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019874res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19875shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019876 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19877 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19878
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019879 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019880 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19881
19882 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019884 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019885 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19886 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19887 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19888 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19889 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19890 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19891 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19892 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019893
19894res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19895shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019896 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19897 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19898
19899 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019900 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019901
19902 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019904res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19905shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019906 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19907 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19908
19909 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19910
19911 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019912
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019913res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19914 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19915 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19916 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019917 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19918
19919 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019921res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19922shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019923 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19924 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19925
19926 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19927
19928 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019929
19930res.hdrs : string
19931 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19932 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19933 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019934 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19935
19936 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019937
19938res.hdrs_bin : binary
19939 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19940 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19941 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19942 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19943 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19944 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19945 (length of 0 for both).
19946
19947 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19948
19949 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19950 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019952res.ver : string
19953resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19954 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019955 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19956
19957 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019959 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019960 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019962set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19963 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19964 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019965 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019966 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019968 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19969 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019971status : integer
19972 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19973 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019974 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19975
19976 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019977
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019978unique-id : string
19979 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19980 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19981 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19982 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19983 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19984 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019986url : string
19987 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19988 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19989 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19990 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19991 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19992 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
Willy Tarreau3706e172023-08-08 19:35:25 +020019993 also "path" and "base". Please note that any fragment reference in the URI
19994 ('#' after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
19995 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
19996 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
19997 will also appear in the url.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019999 ACL derivatives :
20000 url : exact string match
20001 url_beg : prefix match
20002 url_dir : subdir match
20003 url_dom : domain match
20004 url_end : suffix match
20005 url_len : length match
20006 url_reg : regex match
20007 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020009url_ip : ip
20010 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20011 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20012 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20013 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
20014 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
20015 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
20016 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020018url_port : integer
20019 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
20020 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
20021 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
20022 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020023
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020024urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20025url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020026 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20027 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020028 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20029 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20030 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20031 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020032 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20033 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020034 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20035 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020037 ACL derivatives :
20038 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20039 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20040 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20041 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20042 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20043 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20044 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20045 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020046
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020048 Example :
20049 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20050 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20051 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20052 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020053
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020054urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020055 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20056 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20057 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020058
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020059url32 : integer
20060 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20061 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20062 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20063 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20064 is an unsigned integer.
20065
20066url32+src : binary
20067 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20068 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20069 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20070
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020071
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200200727.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020073---------------------------------------
20074
20075This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20076used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20077purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20078There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20079or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20080any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20081for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20082
20083internal.htx.data : integer
20084 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20085 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20086
20087internal.htx.free : integer
20088 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20089 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20090
20091internal.htx.free_data : integer
20092 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20093 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20094
20095internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020096 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20097 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20098 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020099
20100internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20101 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20102 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20103
20104internal.htx.size : integer
20105 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20106 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20107
20108internal.htx.used : integer
20109 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20110 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20111 direction.
20112
20113internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20114 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20115 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20116 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20117 of the special value :
20118 * head : The oldest inserted block
20119 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020120 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020121
20122internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20123 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20124 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20125 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20126 integer or one of the special value :
20127 * head : The oldest inserted block
20128 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020129 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020130
20131internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20132 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20133 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20134 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20135 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20136
20137 * head : The oldest inserted block
20138 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020139 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020140
20141internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20142 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20143 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20144 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20145 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20146
20147 * head : The oldest inserted block
20148 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020149 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020150
20151internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20152 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20153 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20154 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20155 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20156
20157 * head : The oldest inserted block
20158 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020159 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020160
20161internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20162 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20163 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20164 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20165 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20166
20167 * head : The oldest inserted block
20168 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020169 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020170
20171internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20172 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20173 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20174 it returns false.
20175
20176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200201777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020178---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020180Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20181every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020182order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020184ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020185---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20186FALSE always_false never match
20187HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20188HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20189HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020190HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020191HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20192HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20193HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20194HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20195LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20196METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20197METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20198METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20199METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20200METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20201METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20202METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20203METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20204RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20205REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20206TRUE always_true always match
20207WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20208---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020209
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202118. Logging
20212----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020213
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020214One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20215provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20216very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20217provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20218state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020219to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020220headers.
20221
20222In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20223about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20224send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20225
20226 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20227 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20228 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20229 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20230 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020231 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020232 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020233
20234The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20235allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20236as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20237while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20238real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20239delay.
20240
20241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202428.1. Log levels
20243---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020244
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020245TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020246source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020247HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20248in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20249track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20250syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20251about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020252
20253
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202548.2. Log formats
20255----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020256
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020257HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020258and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20259slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20260options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020261
20262 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20263 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20264 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20265 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20266 extents.
20267
20268 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20269 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20270 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20271 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20272 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20273
20274 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20275 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20276 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20277 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20278 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20279
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020280 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20281 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20282 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20283 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20284
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020285 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20286
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020287Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20288specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20289field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20290servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20291always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20292identifier.
20293
20294Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20295 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20296 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20297 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20298 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20299
20300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203018.2.1. Default log format
20302-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020303
20304This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20305as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20306format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20307
20308 Example :
20309 listen www
20310 mode http
20311 log global
20312 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20313
20314 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20315 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20316 (www/HTTP)
20317
20318 Field Format Extract from the example above
20319 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20320 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20321 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20322 4 'to' to
20323 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20324 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20325
20326Detailed fields description :
20327 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20328 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20329 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20330 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20331 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20332 and processed the connection.
20333 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20334
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020335In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20336"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20337connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20338
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020339It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20340will eventually disappear.
20341
20342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203438.2.2. TCP log format
20344---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020345
20346The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20347is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20348information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20349counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20350emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20351environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20352the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20353sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020354specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20355not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20356fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20357marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020358
20359 Example :
20360 frontend fnt
20361 mode tcp
20362 option tcplog
20363 log global
20364 default_backend bck
20365
20366 backend bck
20367 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20368
20369 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20370 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20371 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20372
20373 Field Format Extract from the example above
20374 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20375 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20376 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20377 4 frontend_name fnt
20378 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20379 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20380 7 bytes_read* 212
20381 8 termination_state --
20382 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20383 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20384
20385Detailed fields description :
20386 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020387 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020388 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20389 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020390 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020391 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020392 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020393
20394 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020395 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20396 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20397 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020398
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020399 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020400 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20401 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020402 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20403 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20404 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20405 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020406
20407 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20408 and processed the connection.
20409
20410 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20411 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20412 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20413 applications.
20414
20415 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20416 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20417 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20418 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20419 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20420
20421 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20422 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20423 See "Timers" below for more details.
20424
20425 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20426 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20427 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20428 "Timers" below for more details.
20429
20430 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020431 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020432 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20433 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20434 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20435 details.
20436
20437 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20438 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20439 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20440 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20441 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20442
20443 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20444 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20445 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20446 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20447 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20448 for more details.
20449
20450 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020451 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020452 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20453 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20454 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020455 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020456
20457 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20458 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20459 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20460 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20461 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20462 caused by a denial of service attack.
20463
20464 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20465 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20466 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20467 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20468 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20469 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20470 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20471 denial of service attack.
20472
20473 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20474 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20475 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20476 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20477 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20478 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20479 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20480 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20481 be processed than on other servers.
20482
20483 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20484 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20485 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20486 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020487 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020488 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20489 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20490 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20491 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20492 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20493 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20494 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20495 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20496
20497 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20498 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20499 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20500 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20501 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20502 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020503 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020504 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20505
20506 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20507 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20508 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20509 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20510 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20511 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020512 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020513 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20514 occurs.
20515
20516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205178.2.3. HTTP log format
20518----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020519
20520The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20521is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20522the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20523are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20524emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20525generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20526"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20527which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020528frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20529is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020530
20531Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20532slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20533with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20534
20535 Example :
20536 frontend http-in
20537 mode http
20538 option httplog
20539 log global
20540 default_backend bck
20541
20542 backend static
20543 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20544
20545 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20546 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20547 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020548 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020549
20550 Field Format Extract from the example above
20551 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20552 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020553 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020554 4 frontend_name http-in
20555 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020556 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020557 7 status_code 200
20558 8 bytes_read* 2750
20559 9 captured_request_cookie -
20560 10 captured_response_cookie -
20561 11 termination_state ----
20562 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20563 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20564 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20565 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20566 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020567
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020568Detailed fields description :
20569 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020570 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020571 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20572 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020573 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020574 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020575 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020576
20577 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020578 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20579 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20580 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020581
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020582 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020583 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020584
20585 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20586 and processed the connection.
20587
20588 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20589 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20590 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20591
20592 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20593 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20594 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20595 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20596 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20597 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20598
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020599 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20600 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20601 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020602 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020603 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20604 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020605 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020606 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020607
20608 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20609 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020610 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020611
20612 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20613 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020614 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20615 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020616
20617 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20618 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20619 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20620 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20621 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020622 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20623 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020624
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020625 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020626 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20627 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20628 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20629 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20630 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20631 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020632 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020633
20634 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020635 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20636 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020637
20638 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20639 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020640 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020641 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20642 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20643 overflowing.
20644
20645 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20646 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20647 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20648 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20649 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20650 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20651 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20652 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20653
20654 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20655 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20656 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20657 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20658 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20659 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20660 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20661 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20662
20663 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20664 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20665 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20666 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20667 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20668 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20669 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20670
20671 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020672 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020673 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20674 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20675 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020676 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020677 system.
20678
20679 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20680 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20681 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20682 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20683 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20684 caused by a denial of service attack.
20685
20686 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20687 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20688 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20689 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20690 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20691 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20692 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20693 denial of service attack.
20694
20695 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20696 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20697 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20698 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20699 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20700 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20701 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20702 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20703 processed than on other servers.
20704
20705 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20706 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20707 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20708 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020709 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020710 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20711 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20712 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20713 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20714 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20715 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20716 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20717 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20718
20719 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20720 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20721 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20722 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20723 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20724 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020725 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020726 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20727
20728 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20729 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20730 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20731 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20732 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20733 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020734 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020735 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20736 occurs.
20737
20738 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20739 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20740 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20741 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20742 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20743 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20744 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20745 cookies" below for more details.
20746
20747 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20748 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20749 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20750 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20751 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20752 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20753 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20754 and cookies" below for more details.
20755
20756 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20757 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20758 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20759 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20760 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20761 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20762 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20763 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20764
20765
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200207668.2.4. Custom log format
20767------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020768
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020769The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020770mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020771
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020772HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020773Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20774separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20775prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20776
20777Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20778variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020779("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020780
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020781If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020782as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020783less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20784the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20785
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020786Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20787"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20788delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20789preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020790
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020791Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20792'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20793https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20794such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20795
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020796Flags are :
20797 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020798 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020799 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20800 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020801
20802 Example:
20803
20804 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20805 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20806
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020807 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20808
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020809At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20810
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020811 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20812 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020813
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020814the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020815
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020816 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20817 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20818 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020819
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020820and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20821
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020822 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20823 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020824
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020825Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20826
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020827 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020828 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020829 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20830 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20831 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020832 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20833 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20834 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020835 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020836 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020837 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020838 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020839 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020840 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20841 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020842 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020843 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020844 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020845 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020846 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020847 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020848 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020849 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20850 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20851 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20852 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20853 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020854 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020855 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020856 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020857 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020858 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020859 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20860 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020861 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20862 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20863 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020864 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020865 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20866 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020867 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020868 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20869 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20870 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020871 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020872 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020873 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20874 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20875 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20876 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020877 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020878 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020879 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020880 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020881 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020882 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020883 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20884 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20885 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020886 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020887 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20888 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020889 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020890 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20891 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020892 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020893 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020894 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020895 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020896
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020897 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020898
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020899
209008.2.5. Error log format
20901-----------------------
20902
20903When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020904protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020905By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20906"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020907will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020908logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20909
20910The format looks like this :
20911
20912 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20913 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20914 Connection error during SSL handshake
20915
20916 Field Format Extract from the example above
20917 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20918 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20919 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20920 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20921 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20922
20923These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20924failures.
20925
20926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209278.3. Advanced logging options
20928-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020929
20930Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20931just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20932options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20933for more information about their usage.
20934
20935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209368.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20937------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020938
20939It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020940HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020941commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20942monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20943ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20944
20945 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20946 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20947 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20948 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20949
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020950 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20951 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020952
20953 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20954 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20955 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20956
20957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209588.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20959----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020960
20961The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20962what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20963or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020964"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020965just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20966log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20967after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20968is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20969with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20970with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20971
20972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209738.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20974------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020975
20976Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20977for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20978"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20979retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20980raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20981a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20982file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20983you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20984"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20985
20986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209878.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20988--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020989
20990Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20991multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20992them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20993"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20994logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20995error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20996and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20997too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20998useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20999alternative.
21000
21001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210028.4. Timing events
21003------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021004
21005Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
21006reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
21007the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
21008frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021009mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
21010addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
21011
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021012Timings events in HTTP mode:
21013
21014 first request 2nd request
21015 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
21016 t tr t tr ...
21017 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
21018 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
21019 :<---- Tq ---->: :
21020 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021021 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021022 :<--------- Ta --------->:
21023
21024Timings events in TCP mode:
21025
21026 TCP session
21027 |<----------------->|
21028 t t
21029 ---|----|----|----|----|---
21030 | Th Tw Tc Td |
21031 |<------ Tt ------->|
21032
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021033 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021034 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021035 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
21036 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
21037 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021038 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021039 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
21040 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
21041 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
21042 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021043
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021044 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21045 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21046 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021047 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21048 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21049 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21050 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21051 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21052 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021053
21054 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21055 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21056 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21057 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21058 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21059 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21060 request typed by hand during a test.
21061
21062 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21063 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021064 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021065 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21066 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21067 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21068 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021069
21070 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21071 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21072 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21073 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21074 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21075
21076 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21077 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21078 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21079 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21080 connection never established.
21081
21082 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21083 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21084 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21085 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21086 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21087 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21088 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21089 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21090 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21091 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21092 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21093
William Lallemand90b82122023-07-25 09:06:51 +020021094 - Td: this is the total transfer time of the response payload till the last
21095 byte sent to the client. In HTTP it starts after the last response header
21096 (after Tr).
21097
21098 The data sent are not guaranteed to be received by the client, they can be
21099 stuck in either the kernel or the network.
21100
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021101 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21102 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21103 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21104 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21105 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21106 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21107
21108 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21109
21110 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21111 "Ta" can never be negative.
21112
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021113 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21114 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021115 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21116 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021117 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021118
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021119 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021120
21121 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021122 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21123 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021124
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021125 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21126 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21127 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21128 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21129 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21130 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21131 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21132 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21133
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021134These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21135protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21136that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021137due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21138"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21139that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021140
21141Most common cases :
21142
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021143 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21144 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21145 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21146 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21147 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021148 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021149 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21150 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21151 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21152 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21153 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021154 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021155
21156 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21157 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21158 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21159 of ms on remote networks.
21160
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021161 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21162 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21163 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021164
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021165 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21166 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021167 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021168 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21169 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21170 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21171 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21172 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21173 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021174
21175Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21176
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021177 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021178 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021179 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021180
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021181 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021182 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21183 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21184
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021185 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021186 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21187 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21188 flags.
21189
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021190 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21191 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021192 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21193 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21194 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21195 the client connection was maintained open.
21196
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021197 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021198 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021199 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021200 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21201
21202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212038.5. Session state at disconnection
21204-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021205
21206TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21207"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
212082-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21209each of which has a special meaning :
21210
21211 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21212 session to terminate :
21213
21214 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21215
21216 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21217 server explicitly refused it.
21218
21219 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21220 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21221 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21222 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021223 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021224
Christopher Fauletdd8abeb2023-12-19 08:51:26 +010021225 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021226
21227 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21228 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21229 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21230 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21231 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21232
21233 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21234 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21235 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21236 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21237 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21238
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021239 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021240 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21241
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021242 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021243 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21244 backup connections when going up.
21245
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021246 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021247
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021248 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21249 send or receive data.
21250
21251 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21252 send or receive data.
21253
21254 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21255 with nothing left in the buffers.
21256
21257 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21258
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021259 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021260 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21261
21262 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21263 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21264 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21265 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21266 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21267
21268 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21269 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21270
21271 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21272 server (HTTP only).
21273
21274 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21275
21276 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21277 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21278 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21279
21280 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21281 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21282 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21283
21284 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21285
21286 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21287 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21288
21289 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21290 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21291 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21292
21293 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21294 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021295 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21296 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021297
21298 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21299 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21300 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21301 another server.
21302
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021303 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021304 server.
21305
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021306 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21307 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21308 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21309 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21310
21311 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21312 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21313 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21314 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21315
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021316 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21317 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21318 "use-server" rule).
21319
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021320 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21321
21322 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21323 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21324
21325 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21326
21327 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21328 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21329 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21330
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021331 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21332 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021333 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021334 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21335 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21336
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021337 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21338
21339 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21340 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21341
21342 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21343
21344 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21345
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021346The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21347was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021348helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21349starvation, attacks, etc...
21350
21351The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21352alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21353easier finding and understanding.
21354
21355 Flags Reason
21356
21357 -- Normal termination.
21358
21359 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021360 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21361 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021362 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21363
21364 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21365 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021366 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21367 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021368 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21369 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021370
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021371 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21372 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021373 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021374
21375 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21376 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21377 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21378
21379 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21380 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21381 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21382 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21383 the server takes too long to respond.
21384
21385 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21386 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21387 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21388 long a time to respond.
21389
21390 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21391 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21392 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021393 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021394 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21395 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021396
21397 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21398 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21399 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21400 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21401 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021402 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021403 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21404 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21405 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21406 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21407 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21408 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21409 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21410 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021411 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021412 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21413 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21414 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021415
21416 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21417 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021418 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21419 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21420 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21421 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021422
Christopher Fauletdd8abeb2023-12-19 08:51:26 +010021423 LC The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. The
21424 request was not sent to the server. It only happens with a redirect
21425 because of a "redir" parameter on the server line.
21426
21427 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. The
21428 request was not sent to the server. Generally it means a redirect was
21429 returned, an HTTP return statement was processed or the request was
21430 handled by an applet (stats, cache, Prometheus exported, lua applet...).
21431
21432 LH The response was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
21433 it means a redirect was returned or an HTTP return statement was
21434 processed.
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021435
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021436 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021437 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21438 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021439 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021440 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21441 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21442
21443 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21444 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21445 503 or 504 here.
21446
21447 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021448 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021449 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21450 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21451 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21452
21453 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21454 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021455 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021456 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021457 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021458
21459 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21460 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21461 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21462 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21463 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21464 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021465 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021466
21467 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21468 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21469 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21470 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21471 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21472 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21473 solution is to fix the application.
21474
21475 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21476 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21477 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21478 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21479 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21480 external attacks.
21481
21482 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021483 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021484 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021485 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21486 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21487
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021488 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21489 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21490 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021491 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021492 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021493
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021494 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21495 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21496 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21497 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021498 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21499 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21500 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21501 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021502 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
21503 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
21504 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
21505 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021506
21507 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21508 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21509 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021510 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
21511 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
21512 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
21513 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021514
21515 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21516 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21517 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21518 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21519
21520 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21521 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21522 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21523 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21524
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021525The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021526persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021527important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21528re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21529
21530 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21531
21532 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21533 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21534 set on a GET request.
21535
21536 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21537 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021538 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021539 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21540
21541 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21542 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21543 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21544
21545 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21546 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21547 already got a cookie.
21548
21549 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21550 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21551 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21552 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21553 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21554
21555 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21556 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21557 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21558
21559 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21560 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21561 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21562
21563 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21564 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21565
21566 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21567 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21568 then advertised in the response.
21569
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215718.6. Non-printable characters
21572-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021573
21574In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21575consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21576converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21577prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21578being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21579escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21580is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21581'}' when logging headers.
21582
21583Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21584issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21585containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21586
21587Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21588the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21589performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21590
21591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215928.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21593---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021594
21595Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21596achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021597section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021598cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21599the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21600the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021601locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021602not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21603user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21604a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21605wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21606
21607 Examples :
21608 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21609 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21610
21611 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21612 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21613
21614
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216158.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21616---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021617
21618Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21619proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21620the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21621server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21622
21623Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21624response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021625section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021626
21627It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021628time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21629appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021630are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21631and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21632follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21633request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21634in the logs.
21635
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021636As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21637frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21638an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21639
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021640 Example :
21641 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21642 listen proxy-out
21643 mode http
21644 option httplog
21645 option logasap
21646 log global
21647 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21648
21649 # log the name of the virtual server
21650 capture request header Host len 20
21651
21652 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21653 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21654
21655 # log the beginning of the referrer
21656 capture request header Referer len 20
21657
21658 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21659 capture response header Server len 20
21660
21661 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21662 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21663
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021664 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021665 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21666
21667 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21668 capture response header Via len 20
21669
21670 # log the URL location during a redirection
21671 capture response header Location len 20
21672
21673 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21674 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21675 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21676 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21677 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21678
21679 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21680 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21681 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21682 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021683 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021684
21685 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21686 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21687 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21688 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21689 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021690 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021691
21692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216938.9. Examples of logs
21694---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021695
21696These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21697them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21698reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21699
21700 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21701 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21702 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21703
21704 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21705 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21706
21707 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21708 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21709 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21710
21711 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21712 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21713
21714 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21715 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21716 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21717
21718 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021719 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021720 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21721 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21722
21723 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21724 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21725 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21726
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021727 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21728 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21729 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21730 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021731 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021732 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021733
21734 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021735 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021736
21737 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21738 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21739 Nothing was sent to any server.
21740
21741 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21742 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21743
21744 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21745 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021746 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021747 send a 408 return code to the client.
21748
21749 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21750 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21751
21752 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21753 5 seconds ("c----").
21754
21755 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21756 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021757 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021758
21759 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021760 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021761 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21762 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21763 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21764 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21765 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021766
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021767
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200217689. Supported filters
21769--------------------
21770
21771Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21772accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21773unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21774
21775See also : "filter"
21776
217779.1. Trace
21778----------
21779
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021780filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021781
21782 Arguments:
21783 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21784 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21785
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021786 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021787
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021788 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021789 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21790 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21791 amount of the parsed data.
21792
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021793 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021794
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021795This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21796callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21797information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21798filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21799
21800Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21801tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21802a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21803
21804
218059.2. HTTP compression
21806---------------------
21807
21808filter compression
21809
21810The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21811keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021812when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21813fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21814done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21815explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21816filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21817listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21818order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021819
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021820See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21821 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021822
21823
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200218249.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21825--------------------------------------------
21826
21827filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21828
21829 Arguments :
21830
21831 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21832 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21833 parsed.
21834
21835 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21836 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21837 part must be placed in its own scope.
21838
21839The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21840external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021841streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021842exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21843also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21844
21845SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21846the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21847
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021848For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021849"doc/SPOE.txt".
21850
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100218519.4. Cache
21852----------
21853
21854filter cache <name>
21855
21856 Arguments :
21857
21858 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21859
21860The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21861"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021862cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021863other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21864case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21865is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21866filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021867listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21868order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021869
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021870See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21871 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21872
21873
218749.5. Fcgi-app
21875-------------
21876
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021877filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021878
21879 Arguments :
21880
21881 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21882
21883The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21884request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21885reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21886used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21887implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21888used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21889fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21890used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21891order.
21892
21893See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21894 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21895
21896
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100218979.6. OpenTracing
21898----------------
21899
21900The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21901HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21902of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21903Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21904
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021905This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021906
21907The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21908HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21909participates in the work of HAProxy.
21910
21911filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21912
21913 Arguments :
21914
21915 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21916 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21917 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21918 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21919 OpenTracing filters.
21920
21921 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21922 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21923 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21924 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21925 filter must have its own scope defined.
21926
21927More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021928of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021929
21930
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002193110. FastCGI applications
21932-------------------------
21933
21934HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21935feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21936the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21937FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21938servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21939FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21940backend.
21941
21942HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21943application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21944connection.
21945
2194610.1. Setup
21947-----------
21948
2194910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21950--------------------------
21951
21952fcgi-app <name>
21953 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21954 document root must be defined.
21955
21956acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21957 Declare or complete an access list.
21958
21959 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21960 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21961 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21962 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21963 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21964
21965docroot <path>
21966 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21967 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21968 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21969
21970index <script-name>
21971 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21972 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21973 is an optional setting.
21974
21975 Example :
21976 index index.php
21977
21978log-stderr global
21979log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021980 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021981 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21982
21983 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21984 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21985
21986pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21987 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21988 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21989 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21990
21991 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21992 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21993 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21994 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21995
21996 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21997 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21998
21999path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022000 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022001 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
22002 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
22003 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
22004 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
22005 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
22006 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
22007 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022008
22009 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022010 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022011 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
22012 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
22013 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
22014 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022015
22016 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022017 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
22018 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022019
22020option get-values
22021no option get-values
22022 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
22023
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022024 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022025 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
22026
22027 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
22028 application will accept.
22029
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020022030 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
22031 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022032
22033 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050022034 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022035 option is disabled.
22036
22037 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
22038 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
22039 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
22040 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
22041 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
22042 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
22043
22044option keep-conn
22045no option keep-conn
22046 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
22047 sending a response.
22048
22049 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
22050 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22051
22052option max-reqs <reqs>
22053 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22054 accept.
22055
22056 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
22057 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
22058 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22059 to 1.
22060
22061option mpxs-conns
22062no option mpxs-conns
22063 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22064
22065 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22066 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22067
22068set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22069 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22070 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22071 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22072 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22073
22074 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22075 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22076 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22077
22078 Example :
22079 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22080 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22081
22082 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22083
22084
2208510.1.2. Proxy section
22086---------------------
22087
22088use-fcgi-app <name>
22089 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22090
22091 Arguments :
22092 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22093
22094 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22095 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22096 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22097 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22098 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22099
22100 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22101 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22102 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22103 application are evaluated.
22104
22105
2210610.1.3. Example
22107---------------
22108
22109 frontend front-http
22110 mode http
22111 bind *:80
22112 bind *:
22113
22114 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22115 default_backend back-static
22116
22117 backend back-static
22118 mode http
22119 server www A.B.C.D:80
22120
22121 backend back-dynamic
22122 mode http
22123 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22124 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22125
22126 fcgi-app php-fpm
22127 log-stderr global
22128 option keep-conn
22129
22130 docroot /var/www/my-app
22131 index index.php
22132 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22133
22134
2213510.2. Default parameters
22136------------------------
22137
22138A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22139the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022140script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022141applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22142
22143 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22144 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22145 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22146 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22147 | | |
22148 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22149 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22150 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22151 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22152 | | application. |
22153 | | |
22154 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22155 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22156 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22157 | | |
22158 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22159 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22160 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22161 | | the application's configuration. |
22162 | | |
22163 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22164 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22165 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22166 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22167 | | |
22168 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22169 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22170 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22171 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22172 | | be defined. |
22173 | | |
22174 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22175 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22176 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22177 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22178 | | is not set too. |
22179 | | |
22180 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22181 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22182 | | set. |
22183 | | |
22184 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22185 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22186 | | the request. |
22187 | | |
22188 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22189 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22190 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22191 | | |
22192 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22193 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22194 | | script to process the request. |
22195 | | |
22196 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22197 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22198 | | |
22199 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22200 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22201 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22202 | | |
22203 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22204 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22205 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22206 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22207 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22208 | | |
22209 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22210 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22211 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22212 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22213 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22214 | | side. |
22215 | | |
22216 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22217 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22218 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22219 | | connected to. |
22220 | | |
22221 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22222 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22223 | | |
22224 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022225 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22226 | | current HAProxy version. |
22227 | | |
22228 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022229 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22230 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22231 | | |
22232 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22233
22234
2223510.3. Limitations
22236------------------
22237
22238The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22239way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22240during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22241establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22242application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22243or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22244message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22245these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22246and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22247
22248Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22249request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22250requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22251
22252About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22253into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22254fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22255"http-request" ones.
22256
22257Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22258FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22259processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22260must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22261here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022262
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022263
2226411. Address formats
22265-------------------
22266
22267Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22268address.
22269
22270This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22271The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22272of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22273equivalent is '::'.
22274
22275Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22276is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22277
22278This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22279family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22280
22281Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22282configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22283use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22284'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22285
22286Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22287socket type and the transport method.
22288
22289
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002229011.1. Address family prefixes
22291-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022292
22293'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22294
22295'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22296 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22297 listening.
22298
22299'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22300 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22301 on the statement using this address, a port or
22302 a port range may or must be specified.
22303
22304'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22305 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22306 using this address, a port or a port range
22307 may or must be specified.
22308
22309'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22310 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22311 using this address, a port or a port range
22312 may or must be specified.
22313
22314'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22315 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22316 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22317 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22318 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22319 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22320
22321'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22322 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22323 start by slash '/'.
22324
22325
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002232611.2. Socket type prefixes
22327--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022328
22329Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22330type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22331this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22332This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22333but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22334
22335Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
Willy Tarreaudc2b3f82023-01-16 12:07:12 +010022336instead use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes".
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022337
22338If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22339they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22340report this to the maintainers.
22341
22342'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22343 to "stream"
22344
22345'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22346 to "datagram".
22347
22348
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002234911.3. Protocol prefixes
22350-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022351
22352'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22353 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22354 socket type and transport method is forced to
22355 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22356 this address, a port or a port range can or
22357 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22358 of 'stream+ip@'.
22359
22360'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22361 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22362 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22363 statement using this address, a port or port
22364 range can or must be specified.
22365 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22366
22367'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22368 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22369 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22370 statement using this address, a port or port
22371 range can or must be specified.
22372 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22373
22374'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22375 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22376 socket type and transport method is forced to
22377 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22378 this address, a port or a port range can or
22379 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22380 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22381
22382'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22383 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22384 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22385 the statement using this address, a port or
22386 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau26460482023-01-16 12:11:38 +010022387 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022388
22389'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22390 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22391 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22392 the statement using this address, a port or
22393 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau26460482023-01-16 12:11:38 +010022394 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022395
22396'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22397 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22398 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22399
22400'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22401 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22402 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22403
22404In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22405QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22406
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022407/*
22408 * Local variables:
22409 * fill-column: 79
22410 * End:
22411 */